User Command Specifications
1 Cover
Canon projector SX6/SX60/X600 User Commands
ver. 01.0100/05
ver. 01.0100/04
ver. 01.0100/03
ver. 01.0100/02
ver. 01.0100/01
2005.12.27
2005.12.5
2005.11.14
2005.11.10
2005.11.1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
Contents
1 II. Contents
II. Contents
Item
Page
1
1. Overview
2. Communication Specifications
3. Communication Flow
4. Command System
SX50
2
6
7
7
SX6 / SX60 / X600
5. Control Mode
6. Key/Emulation function
7. Power Management Mode
8. Command List
9. Details of command
REMOTE
LOCAL
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
29
30
31
32
33
34
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
71
72
73
74
75
POWER
AUTOSETEXE
BLANK
INPUT
AUTOPC
DOTS
TRACK
HPOS/VPOS
HPIX/VPIX
SEL
ASPECT
IMAGE
BRI
CONT
SHARP
GAMMA
DGAMMA
PROG
WB
WBRGB
SAT
HUE
RGBGAIN
RGBOFFSET
ACADJUST
MEMCADJ
6AXADJ
6AXR~Y
LAMP
RESET
VKS/HKS
AVOL
MUTE
BVOL
IMAGEFLIP
PMM
PJON
NOSIG
NOSHOW
LOGOPOS
LANG
TERMINAL
KEYLOCK
RCCH
GUID
DPON
LEDILLUMINATE
ZSTEPDRV
ZCONTDRV
FSTEPDRV
FCONTDRV
RC
MAIN
GET
GET MODE
GET POWER
GET BLANK
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
Contents
Item
Page
76
GET INPUT
GET DOTS
GET TRACK
77
78
GET HPOS/VPOS
79
GET HPIX/VPIX
GET SEL
80
81
GET ASPECT
GET IMAGE
GET BRI
82
83
84
GET CONT
GET SHARP
GET GAMMA
GET DGAMMA
GET PROG
GET WB
85
86
87
88
89
90
GET WBRGB
GET SAT
91
92
GET HUE
93
GET RGBGAIN
GET RGBOFFSET
94
95
96
97
98
GET ACADJUST
GET MEMCADJ
GET 6AXADJ
GET 6AXR~6AXY
GET LAMP
GET VKS/HKS
GET AVOL
GET MUTE
GET BVOL
GET IMAGEFLIP
GET PMM
GET PJON
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
GET NOSIG
GET NOSHOW
GET LOGOPOS
GET LANG
GET TERMINAL
GET KEYLOCK
GET RCCH
GET GUID
GET DPON
GET LEDILLUMINATE
GET NOSHOWSTATUS
GET FREEZE
GET SIGNALSTATUS
GET LAMPCOUNTER
GET ERR
GET PRODCODE
GET ROMVER
GET COMVER
RANGE
RANGE POWER
RANGE BLANK
RANGE AUTOSETEXE
RANGE INPUT
RANGE DOTS
RANGE TRACK
RANGE HPOS/VPOS
RANGE HPIX/VPIX
RANGE SEL
RANGE ASPECT
RANGE IMAGE
RANGE BRI
RANGE CONT
RANGE SHARP
RANGE GAMMA
RANGE DGAMMA
RANGE PROG
RANGE WB
RANGE WBRGB
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
Contents
Item
Page
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
RANGE SAT
RANGE HUE
RANGE RGBGAIN
RANGE RGBOFFSET
RANGE ACADJUST
RANGE MEMCADJ
RANGE 6AXADJ
RANGE 6AXR~6AXY
RANGE LAMP
RANGE VKS/HKS
RANGE AVOL
RANGE MUTE
RANGE BVOL
RANGE IMAGEFLIP
RANGE PMM
RANGE PJON
RANGE NOSIG
RANGE NOSHOW
RANGE LOGOPOS
RANGE LANG
RANGE TERMINAL
RANGE KEYLOCK
RANGE RCCH
RANGE GUID
RANGE DPON
RANGE LEDILLUMINATE
RANGE ZSTEPDRV
RANGE ZCONTDRV
RANGE FSTEPDRV
RANGE FCONTDRV
10. Error List
11. Other
Appendix 1 Reset Items
Appendix 2 Table of Response Patterns by Command
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
1. Overview
1 1. Overview
1. Overview
・
・
・
These specifications describe the methods of controlling the projector from the PC over an RS-232C connection
Virtually all operations possible with the remote control can be controlled from the PC
The following symbols are used in these specifications.
Symbol
Description
Space with 0 or more characters (20h), Tab (09h), or other separator
Space with 1 or more characters (20h), Tab (09h), or other separator
Separator between parameters △ , △ | □
The data in [ ] can be omitted.
△
□
▽
[ ]
|
Same as OR
:= The definition name is on the left side of this mark, and the definition description is on the right side.
PAGE 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
2. Communication Specifications
4 2. Communication Specifications
2. Communication Specifications
Communication
system
Item
Specifications
Communication system RS-232-C Start-stop synchronization Semi-duplex communication
Transmission speed
Character length
Stop bit
19.2Kbps
8 bits/character
2 bits
Parity
None
Transmission format
Variable-length record with terminal as delimiter
Maximum transmission Maximum of 256 characters (bytes) including delimiters
length
Delimiters
Delimiters are one of CR, LF, CR+LF, Null (0) (Delimiters are identified automatically.)
Response delimiters are identical to command delimiters.
Transmission codes
ASCII code (General-purpose characters: 20h to 7Fh), Tab (09h)
(Codes other than those above and delimiters are considered “other separator codes”)
Uppercase and lowercase of alphabetic characters are considered the same character.
Double-byte characters and single-byte characters are not distinguished. All are considered
single-byte characters.
Communication procedure No procedure
Flow control
Error control
Break signal
Time out
None
None
Not supported
Tc Character :10ms
* For the SX50
interval
:5S
(Timeout between CR and LF is 10ms.) * For the SX6, SX60 or X600
Tr Command/response interval:10S
Connection
Specifications
PC - Projector connection status
COM
PORT
Item
Connection PC: Connected on a "1:1"
system basis with the projector
Specifications
SERVICE
PORT
Connection 3-line connection of SD,
Canon
signal line RD, and SG
Dedicated cable
Connection
Dedicated cable
Projector
PC
The connection diagram is
cable
here.
Send data SD
SD Send data
Receive data RD
RD Receive data
Signal ground SG
SG Signal ground
※ In the projector, none of the signal lines except for the three lines of SD, RD and SG are used!
※ If necessary, loop back its own signals at the PC side.
Control
Mode
The projector has two control modes, the local mode and remote mode.
Most user commands are used in REMOTE mode.
The two modes are set by the REMOTE and LOCAL commands.
REMOTE command
LOCAL mode
REMOTE mode
LOCAL command
・
・
・Initial mode of projector
・The available user commands are limited.
Except for RC and MAIN, all user commands are available in this mode.
None of the remote control and main unit panel buttons except for
POWER can be used.
・
Control is switched to this mode by the REMOTE command.
Communication
system
Communication between the PC and projector is performed by the projector responding bysending a response to the
command sent from the PC.
If AC power is supplied to the projector, communication is possible regardless of whether the power is on or off.
PC
Projector
Commands
Response
PAGE 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
2. Communication Specifications
Commands
Request transmissions sent from PC to the projector
Transmission
format
△<Command character strings> △<Delimiters>
<Command character Character strings consisting of 0 or more alphanumeric
Reference Command List
strings>
characters
<Delimiters>
One of CR (0Dh), LF (0Ah), CR+LF (0Dh+0Ah), Null (00h)
Type
Description
Commands with a command character string length of 0. No command
processing is performed.
Response
Type
Null
OK
■
□
■
■
□
□
■
■
■
■
□
□
■
■
■
■
□
□
□
■
■
■
■
□
□
BUSY
WARN
ERR
Null Commands
Character string
<Null command character string>:= <Character string with length
0>
GET
RANGE
OK
Projector control command. The format is shown below.
Control
Setting
BUSY
WARN
ERR
Control command
Character string
<Control command character string>:= <Control
name>□<Parameter value>
GET
RANGE
OK
Command that sets values for each parameter. The format is shown below.
BUSY
WARN
ERR
Setting command
Character string
<Setting command character strings>:= <Parameter
name>△=△<Parameter value>
For the definition of <Parameter value>, refer to "Parameter definitions."
GET
RANGE
OK
Requests current value of each parameter. The format is shown below.
Reference
BUSY
WARN
ERR
<Reference command character string>:=? △<Parameter name> |
GET□<Parameter name>
GET
Reference
command
Character string
RANGE
OK
Requests range which can be set for each parameter. The format is shown
below.
■
■
■
□
■
BUSY
WARN
ERR
<Range request command character string>:=
RANGE□<Parameter name>
GET
RANGE
PAGE 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
2. Communication Specifications
Transmissions sent from Projector to PC in response to commands from PC
<Response character string> <Delimiter>
Response
Transmission
format
Character strings consisting of one or more ASCII characters.
The first two characters are always <one lowercase letter>:
The first character indicates the response type.
<Response character
string>
Response type
Meaning
State response
Warning
Example
i
i:OK i:BUSY etc.
w:USER_COMMAND..
e:000B INVALID..
g:AVOL=10
w
e
g
r
Error
Reference command response
Range request command response r:VKS=N, -50, 50
<Delimiters>
Type
Delimiters for commands sent from PC
Description
Type
OK
OK
response can be received.
<OK response character string>:=i:OK
After processing of each command is completed, a response is sent indicating that the next command
BUSY
BUSY This response is sent when a command cannot be received during processing.
response Wait for a few moments, and then try sending the command again.
<BUSY response character string>:=i:BUSY
Example: > IMAGE=2
< i:BUSY
WARN
WARN
response
This response is sent when warning information is issued. Note that this command cannot be
executed.
<Warning response character string>:= w:<Warning description>
Example: > IMAGE=2
< w:USER_COMMAND_VERSION_IS_UPDATED
An error message is output.
ERR
ERR
response
<Error response character string>:= e:<Error code>□<Error message>
※
<Error code> is expressed as a four-digit hexadecimal number.
Refer to “Error List”!
※
Example: > abcdefg
< e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND
Request response for each parameter.
GET
GET
response
<GET response character string>:=g<Parameter name>=<Value>
Example: > GET LANG or ? LANG
< g:LANG=JPN
RANGE
RANGE This is the settable range response for each parameter.
response
<Range response character string> := r:<Parameter name>=<Type>, <Setting value range>
※ <For <Setting value range> refer to the RANGE command.
Example: > RANGE CONT
< r:CONT=N, -20, 20
PAGE 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
2. Communication Specifications
Other
Transmission
recognition
Transmission is recognized when delimiter is received.
Even if a maximum transmission length is received, the entire received transmission will be lost unless a delimiter is received.
The <Parameter value> is defined as shown below.
Parameter
value
<Parameter value>:=<Value 1>▽<Value 2> ▽.. ▽ <Value n>
Definition
<Value> := <Numerical value> | <ID> | “<Character string>”
<Numerical value>
:= [<Sign>] <Decimal character string (Min. 1 character to Max. 5 characters)>
The range of valid values is -32768 to 32767.
<ID>
:= 1 or more ASCII characters (20h to 7Fh)
<Character string>
:= 0 or more ASCII characters (20h to 7Fh)
Cable
The connection diagram (example) for the cable connecting the PC and projector is shown below.
Sample 2
PC
PJ
SHIELD
SHIELD
1 CD (DCD)
2 RD (RXD)
3 SD (TXD)
4 ER (DTR)
5 SG (GND)
6 DR (DSR)
7 RS (RTS)
8 CS (CTS)
9 CI (RI)
3 SD (TXD)
5 RD (RXD)
4 SG (GND)
⑥ ⑦ ⑧
③ ④
① ②
5
1
⑤
9
6
Example of self-loopback connections when the
"CS" and "DR" pins are used in the connector of
PC
D-SUB 9pin FEMALE
PJ
the PC.
P
MINI DIN 8pin MALE
Sample 1
Sample 3
PJ
PJ
PC
PC
SHIELD
SHIELD
SHIELD
SHIELD
1 CD (DCD)
2 RD (RXD)
3 SD (TXD)
4 ER (DTR)
5 SG (GND)
6 DR (DSR)
7 RS (RTS)
8 CS (CTS)
9 CI (RI)
1 CD (DCD)
2 RD (RXD)
3 SD (TXD)
4 ER (DTR)
5 SG (GND)
6 DR (DSR)
7 RS (RTS)
8 CS (CTS)
9 CI (RI)
3 SD (TXD)
5 RD (RXD)
3 SD (TXD)
5 RD (RXD)
4 SG (GND)
4 SG (GND)
2 NC
1 RS(RTS)
6 NC
Canon's standard cable is used for
these connections.
Do not use the "RS" pin in the
7 NC
8 NC
Example of minimally required connections.
connector of the PC!
PAGE 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
3. Communication Flow
1 3. Communication Flow
3. Communication Flow
Transmission
At the sending side (PC), the transmission is sent within character intervals of Tc (character interval timeout).
sent
Transmission
received
At the receiving side (Projector), data able to be received within the character interval of Tc is held, and receiving of a
delimiter is considered “transmission received”.
If a received character interval exceeds Tc or a delimiter is not received within 256 characters, all data already received is
lost, and the mode is reset to receive standby again.
Command/
Response
One response is always returned for each command sent from the PC.
(However, note that a response may not be returned when the internal receive buffer overflows due to reception of a large
amount of data.)
PC
Projector
Commands
Response
Within Tr
*The timeout interval between command and response (Tr) is 10 seconds.
If a response is not received within Tr (timeout interval between command and response) while in response reception
standby after sending a command at the PC, resend the command in the “response reception timeout”.
Response
reception
timeout
PAGE 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
4. Command System SX50
1 4. CSX50
4. Command System
SX50. User Command System
Mode change
Switch to Remote mode
Switch to Local mode
REMOTE
LOCAL
Setting/Control
Display setting
Input select
Input signal settings
INPUT
Total number of dots adjustment
Tracking adjustment
DOTS
TRACK
Horizontal/Vertical position adjustment
Horizontal/Vertical resolution adjustment
HPOS/VPOS
HPIX/VPIX
Input signal selection
Screen settings
SEL
*User commands use only automatic selection of input signals.
*Running of Auto PC will change the values set in “Input signal settings”.
User screen registration
ASPECT
AUTOPC
Auto PC
Menu display position setting
User screen setting
User image position
Input when no signal
Screen when nothing shown
Startup screen
LOGOPOS
NOSIG
NOSHOW
PJON
Flip display
IMAGEFLIP
IMAGE
Image quality select
Image
adjustment
Brightness setting
Contrast setting
BRI
CONT
SHARP
GAMMA
DGAMMA
PROG
WB
Sharpness setting
Gamma correction
Dynamic gamma
Progressive
*This is set for each input signal and image quality.
Screen color correction
RGB adjustment WBRGB
Color saturation setting
Hue setting
SAT
HUE
Advanced color adjustment
ACADJUST
6-axis
6AXR~Y
adjustment
Lamp mode setting
LAMP
Image adjustment reset
RESET
RESET IMAGE
System setting
Terminal setting
Power management
Electronic sound
Key lock
TERMINAL
PMM
BVOL
KEYLOCK
Password registration
Password setting
Remote control setting
Language setting
Reset
RCCH
LANG
RESET
RESET SYSTEM
Remote control/Key
Power supply
Input switching
Keystone
POWER
INPUT
VKS/HKS
AUTOPC
Auto PC
*Running of Auto PC will change the values set in “Input signal settings”.
*Same as “Setting/Control”-“Image Adjustment”-“Image Quality Select”.
Spotlight
Volume adjustment
Digital zoom
AVOL
Image quality select
Audio mute
IMAGE
MUTE
No show status setting
Freeze image
Presentation timer setting
Emulate
Remote control emulate
Key emulate
RC
MAIN
Reference
Retrieve each data
GET
Setting range request
RANGE
※
Indicates functions that are available in the menu but not available in the user commands.
PAGE 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
SX6 / SX60 / X600
1
SX6 / SX60 / X600
SX6, SX60 or X600 User Command System
Mode change
Switch to Remote mode
Switch to Local mode
REMOTE
LOCAL
Setting/Control
Display setting
Input select
INPUT
Total number of dots adjustment
Tracking adjustment
DOTS
Input signal settings
TRACK
Horizontal/Vertical position adjustment
Horizontal/Vertical resolution adjustment
HPOS/VPOS
HPIX/VPIX
Input signal selection
Screen settings
SEL
*User commands use only automatic selection of input signals.
ASPECT
AUTOPC
Auto PC
*Running of Auto PC will change the values set in “Input signal settings”.
Menu display position setting
Screen color correction
WB
RGB adjustment
WBRGB
Progressive
PROG
User screen setting
User screen registration
User image position
LOGOPOS
NOSIG
Screen when no signal
Screen when nothing shown
Startup screen
NOSHOW
PJON
Flip display
IMAGEFLIP
IMAGE
Image quality select
Image
adjustment
Brightness setting
Contrast setting
BRI
CONT
SHARP
GAMMA
Sharpness setting
Gamma correction
Color adjustment
Color saturation setting
SAT
Hue setting
HUE
*This is set for each input signal and image quality.
Gain adjustment
Offset adjustment
RGBGAIN
RGBOFFSET
Advanced adjustment
Dynamic gamma
DGAMMA
MEMCADJ
6AXADJ
Memory color correction
6-axis color adjustment
6-axis adjustment
6AXR~Y
Lamp mode setting
RESET IMAGE
LAMP
Image adjustment reset
RESET
System setting
Auto setup
Power management mode
Direct power-on
Electronic sound
Key lock
PMM
DPON
BVOL
KEYLOCK
LANG
Language setting
Guide
GUIDE
LED illumination
Other settings
LEDILLUMINATE
Remote control setting
Password setting
RCCH
Password registration
Lamp counter reset
Factory settings
RESET
RESET
RESET LAMPTIME
RESET SYSTEM
Remote control/Key
Power supply
Auto set
POWER
AUTOSETEXE
IMAGE
Image quality select
Input switching
Auto PC
*Same as “Setting/Control”-“Image Adjustment”-“Image Quality Select”.
*Running of Auto PC will change the values set in “Input signal settings”.
INPUT
AUTOPC
Focus
FCONTDRV
FSETPDRV
ZCONTDRV
ZSETPDRV
VKS/HKS
Zoom
Keystone
Digital zoom
Spotlight
No show status setting
Audio mute
BLANK
MUTE
AVOL
Volume adjustment
Freeze image
Presentation timer setting
Emulate
Remote control emulate
Key emulate
RC
MAIN
Reference
Retrieve each data
GET
Setting range request
RANGE
※
Indicates functions that are available in the menu but not available in the user commands.
PAGE 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
5. Control Mode
1 5. Control Mode
5. Control Mode
The table below shows the states and limitations of the LOCAL and REMOTE control modes.
Mode
LOCAL mode
REMOTE mode
Item
Mode where projector control/operation is
performed by the main unit or remote control.
Initial mode when microcomputer is started.
Mode where projector control/operation is
performed by a PC or other external device.
(The PC or other external device is connected by
a serial cable.)
Description
Constant remote indicator ※2
ALM state indicator
Status
ALM
State indicator
ALM state indicator
LED
・AC power supply to projector
・REMOTE command
・Manual power on/off
・LOCAL command
Transition method
・Power management standby/exit mode transfer
Main unit keys All available
Operation Remote control All available
buttons keys
Only POWER button is available
Only POWER button is available
※1
Emulation
Available
Not available
5 minutes elapsed from no signal
Operation is as follows depending on the model.
Model
SX50
Operation
・
No switching to standby or exit
mode.
Power
management
standby and exit
modes
Switching
・ 5 minutes elapsed from no
signal
・ Control is switched to "local
mode" after mode switching.
SX6
SX60
X600
※3
・Signal input
・REMOTE command
・Remote control button pressed
・Main unit button pressed
・Emulation
Return
For the SX50
All commands except for "RC" and "MAIN"
Command/parameter
Remarks
REMOTE
LOCAL
GET MODE
MAIN
RC
For the SX6, SX60 or X600
Command/parameter
Remarks
GET COMVER
GET ERROR
GET FREEZE
GET INPUT
GET LAMPCOUNTER
GET MODE
GET MUTE
Commands supported
GET NOSHOWSTATUS
GET POWER
GET PRODCODE
GET ROMVER
GET SIGNALSTATUS
LOCAL
MAIN
RC
REMOTE
Special mode
Executable with remote control or main unit buttons Not executable in any state
(Service mode)
*1 However, switching to the USB mouse function or Special mode is not allowed.
*2 If the control mode is REMOTE, the following are displayed regardless of whether the power is on or off.
*3 When the power management setting is "standby" or "exit"
LED indicator pattern during REMOTE mode
■
■
PAGE 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
6. Key/Emulation function
1 6. Key/Emulation function
6. Key/Emulation function
The table below shows how the main unit/remote control keys and emulation function operate in each control mode
LOCAL mode
Remote
control lock
REMOTE mode
Remote control
lock
Main unit
key lock
Main unit key
lock
Key/Emulation
Unlock
Unlock
Remote control
Main unit keys
×
POWER only
×
POWER only
○
○
○
○
○
×
POWER only POWER only
×
×
×
○
○
○
Remote control emulation
Main unit key emulation
×
×
×
×
○
○
PAGE 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
7. Power Management Mode
1 7. Power Management Mode
7. Power Management Mode
Concerning the processing for switching to the power management standby or exit mode in the remote or local mode
Mode
SX50
SX6/SX60/SX600
Remote The power management standby or exit mode is
not established.
The power management standby or exit mode is
established when no signals are supplied for at least 5
The countdown is aborted by any command other than
GET/RANGE.
(No countdown is initiated.)
Control is switched to the "local mode" in the standby or
exit mode.
Local
The power management standby or exit mode is established when no signals are supplied for at least 5
minutes.
Events for returning from standby mode
・Signal input
・Pressing of a button on main unit or remote control
・REMOTE command
・RC/MAIN command (excluding RC/MAIN*-REP)
Projecting in
progress
Lamp on
Lamp off
Lamp
cooling in
progress
When the standby
mode is established
Power management activated
Processing only for commands
enabled in power management
standby mode
When the exit mode is established
Power Off
PAGE 11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
8. Command List
1 8. Command List
8. Command List
Command type
Control Setting Reference
Item
Commands
Description
Switching to Remote mode
Switching to Local mode
Power supply control
Auto setup execution
BLANK function
Mode
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
REMOTE
LOCAL
POWER
AUTOSETEXE
BLANK
INPUT
AUTOPC
DOTS
○
○
○
○
○
○
Input terminal select
Auto PC execution
○
Total number of dots adjustment
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
TRACK
Tracking adjustment
Input
signal
settings
10 HPOS
11 VPOS
12 HPIX
13 VPIX
Horizontal position adjustment
Vertical position adjustment
Horizontal resolution adjustment
Vertical resolution adjustment
14 SEL
Input signal selection
Screen settings
Image mode
Brightness setting
Contrast setting
Sharpness setting
Gamma correction
Dynamic gamma
15 ASPECT
16 IMAGE
17 BRI
18 CONT
19 SHARP
20 GAMMA
21 DGAMMA
22 PROG
23 WB
24 WBRGB
25 SAT
26 HUE
27 RGBGAIN
28 RGBOFFSET
29 ACADJUST
30 ACADJUST
31 6AXADJ
32 6AXR
33 6AXG
34 6AXB
35 6AXC
36 6AXM
37 6AXY
38 LAMP
Progressive
Screen color correction
Screen color correction (RGB adjustment)
Color saturation setting
Hue setting
RGB gain adjustment
RGB offset adjustment
Advanced color adjustment
Memory color correction
6-axis adjustment ON/OFF
R setting
G setting
6-axis
B setting
color
C setting
adjust
M setting
Y setting
Lamp mode setting
39 RESET
40 VKS
41 HKS
42 AVOL
43 MUTE
44 BVOL
45 IMAGEFLIP
46 PMM
Reset
○
Trapezoid adjustment (vertical keystone)
Trapezoid adjustment (horizontal keystone)
Volume adjustment
Mute
Beep sound setting
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
Flip display control
Power management
47 PJON
Display screen at startup setting
Display screen when no signal setting
Display screen setting when nothing shown
User image position setting
Language selection
Terminal setting
Key lock setting
Remote control setting
Guide setting
Direct power-on setting
Emotional LED and signal sensing LED lighting control
Zoom lens step drive control
Zoom lens continuous drive control
Focus lens step drive control
Focus lens continuous drive control
Remote control operation emulation
Front panel button operation emulation
Retrieve data
48 NOSIG
49 NOSHOW
50 LOGOPOS
51 LANG
52 TERMINAL
53 KEYLOCK
54 RCCH
55 GUIDE
56 DPON
57 LEDILLUMINATE
58 ZSTEPDRV
59 ZCONTDRV
60 FSTEPDRV
61 FCONTDRV
62 RC
○
○
63 MAIN
64 GET
○
○
65 RANGE
Setting range request
PAGE 12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command
1 9. Details of command
9. Details of command
Descriptions of each command are provided starting from the next page.
The command descriptions have the format shown below.
※Command type
* Alphabetic command name
Mode Control Setting Reference
Commands
Function * This briefly describes the command function.
Format * This indicates the command format.
Parameter * This explains the required parameters for the command.
Parameter types
Response
* This describes the command response.
Description * This includes the command function, conditions, and notes.
Example * This provides command usage examples.
Commands
supported
SX50
01.****
○
SX6
11.****
○
SX60
11.****
○
X600
11.****
○
Indicated here are the commands supported by each model (and user command version). "O": supported; "x":
not supported.
*
Supported Command States
* This defines the environments that support the command (power supply state, input signal
state, control mode).
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
×
○
○
○
×
○
×
×
○
×
×
○
×
The command is enabled in states marked by “○”.
The command is enabled
in control modes marked
by “○”.
“○” when the power supply state is enabled while power management is in standby.
Input signal is required when “×”.
“○” when power supply state is ON.
“○” when power supply state is OFF.
PAGE 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
(SET command)
0
PAGE 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
(GET command)
0
PAGE 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
(RANGE command)
0
PAGE 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command REMOTE
1
REMOTE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
REMOTE
Function Switch to Remote mode
Format REMOTE
Parameter None
Response
"i:OK" is returned when it was possible to switch the mode properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This switches to Remote mode.
-1
-2
During Remote mode, all buttons are disabled except for the front panel and remote control
POWER button.
This command can be used in any projector mode.
However, zoom or focus lens drive stops if the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
If, in the power management standby status, the "REMOTE" command was received and
operation was switched to the remote mode, the "power-on" (lamp lighted) status is established
unconditionally.
-3
-4
With the SX50, the setting, control and reference commands except for RC and MAIN can be
used only in the remote mode.
(RC and MAIN can be used only in the "local mode.")
With the SX6, SX60 and X600, there are several setting, control and reference commands
which can be used in the local mode.
(Refer to the LOCAL command.)
-5 When this command is executed, all the statuses and settings listed below are cleared.
・Digital zoom
・Presentation timer display
・Spotlight display
・Screen temporary off (NoShow)
・Freeze image (Freeze)
・Command now being executed (except during "user image registration")
・Focusing, zooming underway (with the SX6, SX60 and X600)
-6 "Guide display" is not cleared by the transfer of operation to the remote mode. If necessary,
clear the display using the GUIDE command.
-7 The current mode can be referenced using the applicable GET command.
Example Mode switching
> REMOTE
< i:OK
Mode viewing
> GET MODE or
< g:MODE=LOCAL
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
○
○
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
PAGE 14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command LOCAL
1
LOCAL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
LOCAL
Function Switch to Local mode
Format LOCAL
Parameter None
Response
"i:OK" is returned when it was possible to switch the mode properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This switches to Local mode.
-1
The following commands can be used while the local mode is established.
Errors supported by model
SX50 SX6 SX60 X600
Command/parameter
01.00** 01.01** 01.01** 01.01**
REMOTE
LOCAL
GET MODE
GET COMVER
GET ERR
GET FREEZE
GET INPUT
GET LAMPCOUNTER
GET MUTE
GET NOSHOWSTATUS
GET POWER
GET PRODCODE
GET ROMVER
GET SIGNALSTATUS
MAIN
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
RC
-2
This command can be used in any projector mode.
However, zoom or focus lens drive stops if the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-3 The current mode can be referenced using the applicable GET command.
-4
The "BLANK status" is cleared. Refer to BLANK command.
Example Mode switching
> LOCAL
< i:OK
Mode viewing
> GET MODE or ?MODE
< g:MODE=LOCAL
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
○
○
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
PAGE 15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command POWER
1
POWER
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
POWER
Function This controls the power supply
POWER□<Parameter:ID>
Format
Parameter
Parameter Meaning
ON
Power ON
OFF
Power OFF
ID
The parameters which can be controlled at any given point in time can be obtained
using the RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response
"i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This performs ON/OFF control of the power supply.
-1 This command is identical to pressing the POWER button on the remote control or main unit.
-2 Provided that the remote mode is established, the command can be executed in any projector
status.
However, zoom or focus lens drive stops if the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-3
-4
After sending this command, use GET POWER to obtain the power supply state at regular
intervals, and check that it is in the controlled state (off or on).
The table below shows the POWER command responses according to the power supply state.
POWER Command Responses by
Power Supply State
Commands
POWER OFF
POWER ON
Status
Off
○
○
○
△
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
Off -> lighted
Lamp on
Lighted -> off
Lighted -> standby
In standby
○
※
○
○: i:OK
△: i:BUSY
Standby -> lighted
-5 The current power supply status can be referenced using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Control
> POWER ON
i:OK
<
Reference
> GET POWER or ?POWER
< g:POWER=OFF
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE POWER
< r:POWER=I,ON,OFF
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command AUTOSETEXE
1
AUTOSETEXE
Commands
Reference
Mode Control Setting
AUTOSETEXE
Function Auto setup
Format
AUTOSETEXE□<Auto set parameter:ID>
Parameter Auto set parameters
Parameter Meaning
FOCUS Auto focusing
VKS
Auto keystone (vertical) execution
Automatic screen color correction
execution
INPUT Automatic signal sensing execution
SCRN
ID
The parameters which can be controlled at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response “i:OK” is returned when the automatic processing was completed successfully.
One of the following responses is returned if an error has been detected at any part of the auto setup.
Type
Error response
FOCUS
VKS
SCRN
e:F002 SYSTEM (FOCUS)
e:F004 SYSTEM (AUTO_KEYSTONE)
e:F005 SYSTEM (SCREEN_COLOR)
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to execute auto setup.
(1) It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
(2) There are no parameters to be executed together. Execute them separately.
(3) It is not possible to execute auto setup in some projector statuses.
)
Statuses in which auto setup
cannot be executed
Type
Remarks
Auto setup cannot be executed Refer to the BLANK
FOCUS
VKS
while "BLANK" is underway.
-
Auto setup cannot be executed Refer to the BLANK
command.
SCRN
while "BLANK" is underway.
Auto setup cannot be executed
if there are no input signals.
command.
INPUT
When automatic screen color correction (SCRN) has been completed successfully, the screen color
correction (WB) is set to "ADJUST."
(4)
Example Setting
> AUTOSETEXE FOCUS
Auto focusing is executed.
< I:OK
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE AUTOSETEXE
<r:AUTOSETEXE=I, FOCUS, VKS, SCRN, INPUT
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
Commands
supported 01.00**
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
○
-
○
-
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
SX60
X600
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command BLANK
1
BLANK
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
BLANK
Function BLANK function
Format
BLANK=<BLANK parameter:ID>
Parameter BLANK parameters
Parameter Meaning
ON
OFF
BLANK ON
BLANK OFF
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to set the BLANK function.
(1) This command functions only when the projector is in the "remote mode." It cannot be executed
by a menu operation or button operation.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
(2) Only a black screen is displayed.
)
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
(3) No input signals and none of the on-screen displays appear while BLANK is underway.
(4) The “display setting,” "image adjustment" and other commands can be executed even while BLANK
is underway.
However, the “AUTOSETEXE=FOCUS” and “AUTOSETEXE=SCRN” commands cannot be executed.
Refer to the AUTOSETEXE command.
(5) The BLANK function is released in the following situations.
a. When the POWER button on the remote control or panel has been pressed
b. When power management standby countdown has started
c. When the mode has been switched from remote to local
d. Power Off
(6) The current BLANK settings can be obtained using the GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> BLANK=ON
< i:OK
BLANK is set to ON.
Reference
> GET BLANK or ?BLANK
g:BLANK=ON
The current BLANK status is referenced.
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE BLANK
< r:BLANK=I, OFF, ON
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
○
-
○
-
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
SX60
X600
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command INPUT
1
INPUT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
INPUT
Function Input selection
INPUT=<Input selection parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Input selection parameters
Parameter Meaning
Errors supported by model
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
D-RGB D-RGB
A-RGB1 A-RGB1
A-RGB2 A-RGB2
COMP Component
VIDEO Video
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
ID
S-VIDEO S-Video
D-VIDEO Digital Video
SCARTRGB
SCART(RGB)
×
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response
"i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This controls the input selection.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
This command has the same function as the buttons listed in the table below.
-2
Model Button
「Computer-1」、「〃-2」、「VIDEO/S」
SX50
SX6
SX60 INPUT
X600
-3 When the model SX50 is used, "A-RGB2" and "COMP" cannot be selected if "OUT" has been
set using the TERMINAL command. ('e:1001 TERMINAL_OUT' is returned.)
-4 When the model SX6, SX60 or X600 is used, the input can be selected automatically using the
auto setup command (AUTOSETEXE=INPUT).
Refer to the AUTOSETEXE command.
-5 The current input can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> INPUT=VIDEO
VIDEO input selection
< i:OK
Reference
> GET INPUT or ?INPUT
< g:INPUT=A-RGB1
This retrives the input signal
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE INPUT
< r:INPUT=I, D-RGB, A-RGB1, A-RGB2, COMP, VIDEO, S-VIDEO, D-VIDEO, SCARTRGB
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command AUTOPC
1
AUTOPC
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
AUTOPC
Function Auto PC
Format
AUTOPC
Parameter None
Response
'i:OK' is returned when control has been executed successfully.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description Auto PC execution
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
Furthermore, it may not be possible to execute the command with some input signals.
-2 This command is identical to pressing the “AUTOPC” button on the remote control or front pane
-3 Execution of this command may modify the following setting values.
・Total number of dots
・Tracking
・Horizontal/vertical positions
・Number of horizontal/vertical display dots
-4 To confirm modified setting values, use the GET command of the respective parameter.
For details, refer to the GET commands below.
Setting
Total number of dots
Tracking
Horizontal position
Vertical position
GET
GET DOTS
GET TRACK
GET HPOS
GET VPOS
Number of horizontal display dots GET HPIX
Number of vertical display dots GET VPIX
Example > AUTOPC
< i:OK
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command DOTS
1
DOTS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
DOTS
Function Total number of dots adjustment
Format DOTS=<Number of dots: Number>
Parameter Number of dots
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description 1 This designates the total number of dots for one horizontal period.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
Furthermore, it may not be possible to execute the command with some input signals.
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [Total number of dots adjustments]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [Total number of dots]
X600
-3
The GET command can be used to obtain the current total number of dots.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> DOTS=1650
The total number of dots is 1650.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET DOTS or ?DOTS
< g:DOTS=1200
This retrieves the total number of dots.
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
RANGE DOTS
>
< r:DOTS=N, 0, 4096
Any value from 0 to 4096 can be set for the total dots.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command TRACK
1
TRACK
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
TRACK
Function Tracking adjustment
Format
TRACK=<Adjustment value: Number>
Parameter Adjustment value
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This is used for adjustment when tracking (synchronization) is out of sync and the screen flickers.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
Furthermore, it may not be possible to execute the command with some input signals.
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [Tracking]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [Tracking]
X600
-3 The GET command can be used to retrieve the current tracking adjustment values.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> TRACK=25
< i:OK
The tracking adjustment value is set to 25.
Reference
> GET TRACK or ?TRACK
< g:TRACK=21
This retrieves the tracking adjustment setting value.
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE TRACK
< r:TRACK=N, 0, 31
Any value from 0 to 31 can be set for the tracking.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command HPOS/VPOS
1
HPOS/VPOS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
HPOS/VPOS
Function Horizontal/Vertical position adjustment
Format
HPOS=<Horizontal position: Number>
VPOS=<Vertical position: Number>
Parameter Horizontal/vertical positions
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This adjusts the horizontal and vertical position on the screen.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
Furthermore, it may not be possible to execute the command with some input signals.
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [Horizontal position]
[Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [Vertical position]
SX6
SX60
X600
[Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [Horizontal position]
[Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [Vertical position]
-3 The GET command can be used to retrieve the current horizontal and vertical position.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> HPOS=12
This sets the horizontal position to 12.
This acquires the vertical position.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET VPOS or ?VPOS
< g:VPOS=8
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE HPOS
< r:HPOS=N, 0, 820
Any value from 0 to 820 can be set for the
horizontal position.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command HPIX/VPIX
1
HPIX/VPIX
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
HPIX/ VPIX
Function Horizontal/Vertical resolution adjustment
Format
HPIX=<Horizontal resolution: Number>
VPIX=<Horizontal resolution: Number>
Parameter Horizontal/vertical resolution
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This adjusts the horizontal and vertical resolution (number of dots) on the screen.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
Furthermore, it may not be possible to execute the command with some input signals.
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [No. of horizontal display dots]
[Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [No. of vertical display dots]
SX6
SX60
X600
[Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [No. of horizontal dots]
[Display settings] - [Input signal settings] - [No. of vertical dots]
-3 The GET command can be used to retrieve the current horizontal and vertical position.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> HPIX=1024
This sets the horizontal resolution to 1024.
This retrieves the vertical resolution.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET VPIX or ?VPIX
<
g:VPIX= 864
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE VPIX
< r:VPIX=N, 0, 1000
Any value from 0 to 1000 can be set for the
horizontal resolution.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command SEL
1
SEL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
SEL
Function Input signal selection
Format
SEL=<Input signal selection parameter: ID>
Parameter Input signal selection parameter
Parameter Meaning
AUTO
Auto
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This selects the input signal.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
Furthermore, it may not be possible to execute the command with some input signals.
-2 This command takes effect only with the "AUTO" parameter setting.
-3 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [Input signal selection] - [Auto]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [Input signal selection] - [Auto]
X600
-4 The current input signal can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Parameter Remarks
PAL
Includes PAL-M and PAL-N
SECAM
NTSC Includes NTSC4.43
1080i
1035i
720p
575p
480p
575i
Includes 540p (1080i non-interlaced signal)
Includes 288p (PAL non-interlaced signal)
Includes 240p (NTSC non-interlaced signal)
480i
UNKNOWN No-color, 1080p, and other signals
List of signals which can be detected
Example Setting
> SEL=AUTO
This sets the input signal selection to “AUTO”.
This retrieves the input signal.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET SEL or ?SEL
< g:SEL=575p
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE SEL
< r:SEL=I, AUTO
Only "AUTO" can be set for the input signal selection.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command ASPECT
1
ASPECT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
ASPECT
Function Screen settings
ASPECT=<Screen setting parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Screen setting parameters
Errors supported by model
Parameter Meaning
AUTO Auto
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
○
○
○
○
–
○
○
○
○
–
○
○
○
NORMAL
WIDE
Normal
Wide
ID
FULL
TRUE
Full screen
Real
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the screen sizes.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
Furthermore, it may not be possible to execute the command with some input signals.
-2
The final screen settings are retained even when the power is turned off. However, the screen
settings may be different if the input terminal or input signal is changed.
-3 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [Screen settings]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [Aspect ratio]
X600
-4 The GET command can be used to retrieve the current screen display mode.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> ASPECT=WIDE
This sets the screen size to WIDE.
This retrieves the screen size.
> i:OK
Reference
> GET ASPECT or ?ASPECT
< g:ASPECT=TRUE
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE ASPECT
< r:ASPECT=I, AUTO, NORMAL, WIDE
"AUTO," "NORMAL" or "WIDE" can be set as the
screen size.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model Parameter
Power
Input
Mode
OFF ON PM
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
AUTO
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
×
–
–
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
NORMAL
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
WIDE
–
–
SX50
FULL
–
–
TRUE
×
×
×
–
–
SX6
SX60
X600
AUTO
WIDE
FULL
TRUE
○
○
○
×
×
×
○
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
×
○
○
×
○
○
×
○
○
×
▼
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command IMAGE
2
IMAGE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
IMAGE
Function Image mode setting
IMAGE=<Image mode setting parameter:ID>
Format
Parameter Image mode setting parameters
Errors supported by model
Parameter
Meaning
Standard
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
×
○
○
×
○
○
×
○
×
○
○
×
○
×
○
×
×
STANDARD
PRESENTATION Presentation
CINEMA
SRGB
ADOBE
MOVIE
Cinema
sRGB
ADOBE RGB
Movie
ID
○
MOVIE_PHOTO Movie & Photo
HOME_CINEMA Home theater
○
×
×
○
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the image quality.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The final settings for the image mode are retained even when the power is turned off.
-3 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Image mode settings]
SX6
SX60 [Image adjustments] - [Image mode settings]
X600
-4 Changing the setting may modify the following setting values.
Commands related to the
Setting
Remarks
settings
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Gamma adjustment
Dynamic gamma
Progressive
BRI
CONT
SHARP
GAMMA
DGAMMA
PROG
Screen color correction/RGB WB/ WBRGB
adjustment values
For the SX50
Saturation/hue
Advanced color adjustment
Memory color correction
SAT/ HUE
ACADJUST
MEMCADJ
For the SX50
For the SX6, SX60 or X600
RGB gain/offset adjustments RGBGAIN/RGBOFFSET For the SX6, SX60 or X600
6AXR~Y
6-axis color adjust
-5 The current image quality can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> IMAGE=PRESENTATION
This sets the image mode to "Presentation."
This references the current image mode.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET IMAGE or ?IMAGE
< g:IMAGE=CINEMA
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE IMAG
< r:IMAGE=I, STANDARD, CINEMA, SRGB "STANDARD," "CINEMA" or "SRGB" can be set as
the image mode.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
PAGE 27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
Supported Command States
9. Details of command IMAGE
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command BRI
1
BRI
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
BRI
Function Brightness setting
Format
BRI=<Brightness setting: Number>
Parameter Brightness setting (-20 to 20)
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the screen brightness.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Brightness]
SX6
SX60 [Image adjustments] - [Brightness]
X600
-3 The currently selected input signal and image mode are used for these settings.
-4 The current brightness can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> BRI=-10
This sets the brightness to -10.
This retrieves the brightness.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET BRI or ?BRI
< g:BRI=-10
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE BRI
< r:BRI=N, -20, 20
Any value from -20 to 20 can be set for the brightness.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command CONT
1
CONT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
CONT
Function Contrast setting
Format
CONT=<Contrast setting: Number>
Parameter Contrast setting (-20 to 20)
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the screen contrast.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Contrast]
SX6
SX60 [Image adjustments] - [Contrast]
X600
-3 The currently selected input signal and image mode are used for these settings.
-4 The current contrast can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> CONT=3
This sets the contrast to +3.
This retrieves the contrast.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET CONT or ?CONT
< g:CONT=3
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE CONT
< r:CONT=N, -20, 20
Any value from -20 to 20 can be set for the contrast.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command SHARP
1
SHARP
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
SHARP
Function Sharpness setting
Format
SHARP=<Sharpness setting: Number>
Parameter Sharpness setting (-4 to 4)
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the screen sharpness.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Sharpness]
SX6
SX60 [Image adjustments] - [Sharpness]
X600
-3 This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
-4 The current sharpness can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> SHARP=3
This sets the contrast to 3.
This retrieves the contrast.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET SHARP or ?SHARP
< g:SHARP=3
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE SHARP
< r:SHARP=N, -4, 4
Any value from -4 to 4 can be set for the sharpness.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command GAMMA
1
GAMMA
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GAMMA
Function Gamma adjustment
Format
GAMMA=<Gamma adjustment: Number>
Parameter Gamma adjustment (-4 to 4)
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This performs the Gamma adjustment.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Gamma]
SX6
SX60 [Image adjustments] - [Gamma]
X600
-3 This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
-4 The current gamma adjustment can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> GAMMA=-1
This sets the gamma correction to –1.
This retrieves the gamma correction.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET GAMMA or ?GAMMA
< g:GAMMA=3
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE GAMMA
< r:GAMMA=N, -4, 4
Any value from -4 to 4 can be set for the gamma.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 32
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9. Details of command DGAMMA
User Command Specifications
1
DGAMMA
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
DGAMMA
Function Dynamic gamma
DGAMMA=<Dynamic gamma setting parameter:ID>
Format
Parameter Dynamic gamma setting parameters
Parameter Meaning
0
1
OFF
ON
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description The command is used to set the dynamic gamma function to ON or OFF.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Dynamic gamma]
SX6
SX60 [Image adjustments] - [Advanced adjustments] - [Dynamic gamma]
X600
-3 This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
-4 The current dynamic gamma function status can be acquired using the applicable GET comman
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> DGAMMA=1
< i:OK
This sets the dynamic gamma function to ON.
This retrieves the dynamic gamma function state.
Reference
> GET DGAMMA or ?DGAMMA
< g:DGAMMA=1
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE DGAMMA
< r:DGAMMA=I, 0, 1
The dynamic gamma can be set using "0" or "1."
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command PROG
2
PROG
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
PROG
Function Progressive setting
PROG=<Progressive conversion setting parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Progressive conversion setting parameters
Errors supported by model
Parameter
Meaning
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
0
1
2
OFF
ON
AUTO
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to set the progressive conversion processing to ON or OFF.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
Furthermore, it may not be possible to execute the command with some input signals.
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Progressive]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [Progressive]
X600
-3 This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
-4 The menu display statuses are as listed in the table below by model.
Model Menu display statuses, etc.
If the input signals are "Component" signals of any of the following types, the
signals cannot be processed even when "ON" has been selected as the
progressive conversion setting to perform progressive conversion.
SX50
・1080i ・720p ・480p ・1035i ・575p
When signals from a progressive source have been input, the progressive
SX6 conversion setting can be selected, but the field will be blank on the menu.
SX60
If the input signals are "Component" signals of any of the following types, the
X600 signals cannot be processed even when "ON" or "AUTO" has been selected as the
progressive conversion setting to perform progressive conversion, but the value on
the menu will change. However, the value will be grayed out.
・1080i ・720p ・480p ・1035i ・575p
(Reference)
・1080i
・1035i
・720p ・480p With the SX50, IP_NOT_AVAILABLE is returned for both
referencing and setting in response to the signals on the left.
・575p
-5
The current value can be acquired using the applicable GET command. The significance of the
acquired values is given in the table below.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Model Significance of acquired value
Current progressive conversion processing status (1: conversion underway, 0:
no conversion)
SX50
SX6
SX60 Setting currently established for progressive conversion
X600
Example Setting
> PROG=0
This sets the progressive conversion setting to OFF.
< i:OK
Reference
>
GET PROG or ?PROG
This acquires the progressive conversion processing
status.
< g:PROG=1
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE PROG
< r:PROG=I, 0, 1, 2
"0," "1" or "2" can be selected as the progressive
conversion setting.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
PAGE 34
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command PROG
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command WB
1
WB
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
WB
Function Screen color correction
WB=<Screen color correction parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Screen color correction parameters
Parameter
Meaning
Standard
Blackboard
Adjust
NORMAL
GREENBOARD
ADJUST
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description The screen color correction is set to “Normal”, “Blackboard”, or “Adjust”.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Screen color correction]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [Screen color correction]
X600
-3 When "ADJUST" has been selected, adjust the RGB adjustment values using the WBRGB
command.
-4 When the model SX50 is used, the currently selected input signal and image mode settings are
established.
When the model SX6, SX60 or X600 is used, a set of settings is established for the system.
-5 The current screen color correction can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Control
> WB=NORMAL
i:OK
This sets the screen color correction to “Normal”.
This retrieves the screen color correction.
<
Reference
> GET WB or ?WB
< g:WB=GREENBOARD
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE WB
<
r:WB=I,NORMAL,GREENBOARD,ADJUST "NORMAL," "GREENBOARD" or "ADJUST" can be
set for the screen color correction.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 36
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command WBRGB
1
WBRGB
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
WBRGB
Function Screen color correction (ADJUST)
WBRGB=<R adjustment value: Number>▽<G adjustment value: Number>▽<B
adjustment value: Number>
Format
Parameter RGB setting value (Each value –20 to 20)
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response An 'i:OK' is returned after setting is successful.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the RGB adjustment values of the screen color correction.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2
Although this setting is enabled when Adjustment (ADJUST) is selected by the screen color
correction command (WB), it can be made independently.
-3 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Screen color correction] - [Adjustments]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [Screen color correction] - [Adjustments]
X600
-4 With this command, the R, G, and B values can be set in a single operation.
-5 When the model SX50 is used, the currently selected input signal and image mode settings are
When the model SX6, SX60 or X600 is used, a set of settings is established for the system.
-6 The GET command can be used to retrieve the current RGB adjustment values.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> WBRGB=10, 11, 12
This sets R to 10, G to 11, and B to 12.
This retrieves the RGB adjustment values.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET WBRGB or ?WBRGB
< g:WBRGB=-10, 0, 19
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE WBRGB
< r:WBRGB=N,-20,20,-20,20,-20,20
Any value from -20 to 20 can be set for each color
as the RGB adjustment values.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command SAT
1
SAT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
SAT
Function Color saturation setting
Format
SAT=<Color saturation value setting: Number>
Parameter Saturation setting (-20 to 20)
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the screen color saturation.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
Furthermore, it may not be possible to execute the command with some input signals.
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Saturation]
SX6
SX60 [Image adjustments] - [Color adjustments] - [Saturation]
X600
-3 This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
-4 The GET command can be used to retrieve the current color saturation.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> SAT=-10
This sets the color saturation to –10.
This retrieves the color saturation.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET SAT or ?SAT
< g:SAT=1
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE SAT
< r:SAT=N,-20,20
Any value from -20 to 20 can be set for the saturation.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
×
–
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 38
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command HUE
1
HUE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
HUE
Function Hue setting
HUE=<Hue setting value:Number>
Format
Parameter Hue setting (-20 to 20)
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the screen hue.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
Furthermore, it may not be possible to execute the command with some input signals.
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Hue]
SX6
SX60 [Image adjustments] - [Color adjustments] - [Hue]
X600
-3 An input signal is required when “VIDEO” or “S-VIDEO” is selected.
-4 This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
-5 The GET command can be used to retrieve the current hue.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> HUE=8
This sets the hue to +8.
This retrieves the hue.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET HUE or ?HUE
< g:HUE=1
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE HUE
< r:HUE=N,-20,20
Any value from -20 to 20 can be set for the hue.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
–
–
○
–
–
○
–
○
×
SX50
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
–
–
○
×
SX6
SX60
X600
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
○
×
–
○
○
×
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RGBGAIN
1
RGBGAIN
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RGBGAIN
Function RGB gain adjustment
Format RGBGAIN=<R gain setting:Number>▽<G gain setting:Number>▽<B gain setting:Number>
Parameter RGB gain settings (from -20 to 20 for each value)
Number
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at that time.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to adjust the gain of the R, G and B colors.
(1)
It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
This command functions in the same way as when "Image adjustments" - "Color adjustments" -
"Red/green/blue gain" are selected on the menu.
)
(2)
(3)
(4)
This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
The current RGB gain values can be obtained using the GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> RGBGAIN=10, 11, 12
< i:OK
The R gain is set to 10, G gain to 11 and B gain to 12.
The RGB gain values are obtained.
Reference
> GET RGBGAIN or ?RGBGAIN
< g:RGBGAIN=-10, 0, 19
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE RGBGAIN
< r:RGBGAIN=N,-20,20,-20,20,-20,20
A number from -20 to 20 can be set for each color as
the RGB gain values.
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 40
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RGBOFFSET
1
RGBOFFSET
Commands
Reference
Mode Control Setting
RGBOFFSET
Function RGB offset adjustment
Format
RGBOFFSET=<R offset setting:Number>▽<G offset setting:Number>▽<B offset
setting:Number>
Parameter RGB offset settings (-20 to 20 for each value)
Number
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at that time.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to adjust the offset of the R, G and B colors.
(1)
It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
This command functions in the same way as when "Image adjustments" - "Color adjustments" -
"Red/green/blue offset" are selected on the menu.
)
(2)
(3)
(4)
This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
The current RGB offset values can be obtained using the GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> RGBOFFSET=10, 11, 12
< i:OK
The R offset is set to 10, G offset to 11 and B offset to 12.
The RGB offset values are obtained.
Reference
> GET RGBOFFSET or ?RGBOFFSET
< g:RGBOFFSET=-10, 0, 19
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE RGBOFFSET
< r:RGBOFFSET=N,-20,20,-20,20,-20,20
A number from -20 to 20 can be set for each color as the
RGB offset values.
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command ACADJUST
1
ACADJUST
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
ACADJUST
Function Advanced color adjustment
ACADJUST=<Advanced color adjustment parameter:ID>
Format
Parameter Advanced color adjustment parameters
Parameter
Meaning
NOCORRECT No adjustment
MEM_L
MEM_M
MEM_H
6AX
Low memory color adjustment
Medium memory color adjustment
High memory color adjustment
6-axis adjustment
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description
The advanced color correction method is set by selecting from “No correction”, “Low to High
memory color correction”, and “6-axis adjustment”.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is identical to the Color balance function in the Image adj. menu.
-3
In the case of "6-axis adjustment," set the hue and color saturation of each axis using the 6AXR
to Y "6-axis correction R to Y hue/color saturation setting" commands.
-4 This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
-5 The GET command can be used to retrieve the current color compensation method.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Control
> ACADJUST=MEM_M
The color correction is set to “Medium memory
color adjustment”.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET ACADJUST or ?ACADJUST
< g:ACADJUST=6AX
This retrieves the color correction method.
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE ACADJUST
<
r:ACADJUST=I,NOCORRECT,MEM_L,MEM_M,MEM_H,6AX
"NO CORRECT," "MEM_L," "MEM_M,"
"MEM_H" or "6AX" can be set as the
color correction method.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
×
SX60
01.01**
×
X600
01.01**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
–
○
×
–
×
–
×
–
×
–
○
○
○
–
–
–
–
○
○
×
–
SX50
SX6
–
–
–
–
–
–
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 42
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command MEMCADJ
1
MEMCADJ
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
MEMCADJ
Function Memory color adjustment
Format
MEMCADJ=<Memory color adjustment parameter:ID>
Parameter Memory color adjustment parameters
Parameter
OFF
Meaning
No adjustment
MEM_L
MEM_M
MEM_H
Low memory color adjustment
Medium memory color adjustment
High memory color adjustment
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description
This command is used to select no adjustment (OFF), low (MEM_L), medium (MEM_M) or high (MEM_H) as
the memory color adjustment setting.
(1)
It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
This command functions in the same way as when "Image adjustments" - "Memory color
adjustment" are selected on the menu.
(3)
(4)
This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
The current memory color adjustment setting can be obtained using the GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Control
> MEMCADJ=MEM_M
< i:OK
The color adjustment is set to “Medium memory color
adjustment”.
Reference
> GET MEMCADJ or ?MEMCADJ
< g:MEMCADJ=MEM_M
The memory color adjustment level is obtained.
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE MEMCADJ
< r:MEMCADJ=I,OFF,MEM_L,MEM_M,MEM_H
No adjustment (OFF), low (MEM_L), medium (MEM_M)
or high (MEM_H) can be set for the memory color
adjustment.
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command 6AXADJ
1
6AXADJ
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
6AXADJ
Function 6-axis adjustment ON/OFF
Format
6AXADJ=<6-axis adjustment parameter:ID>
Parameter
Parameter Meaning
ON
OFF
This sets the 6-axis adjustment to ON.
This sets the 6-axis adjustment to OFF.
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to select ON or OFF for the 6-axis adjustment.
(1)
It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
In the case of "6-axis adjustment," set the hue and color saturation of each axis using the 6AXR to
Y "6-axis correction R to Y hue/color saturation setting" commands.
)
(2)
(3)
This command functions in the same way as when "Image adjustments" - "6-axis adjustment" are
selected on the menu.
(4) This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
(5)
The current 6-axis adjustment setting can be obtained using the GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Control
Example
> 6AXADJ=ON
< i:OK
The 6-axis adjustment is set to ON.
Reference
> GET 6AXADJ or ?6AXADJ
< g:6AXADJ=ON
The 6-axis adjustment ON or OFF setting is obtained.
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE 6AXADJ
< r:6AXADJ=I,ON,OFF
The 6-axis adjustment can be set as "ON" or "OFF."
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 44
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command 6AXR-Y
User Command Specifications
1
6AXR-Y
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
6AXR-Y
Function 6-axis correction R-Y hue/saturation settings
6AXR=<R hue: Number>▽<R saturation: Number>
Format
6AXG=<G hue: Number>▽<G saturation: Number>
6AXB=<B hue: Number>▽<B saturation: Number>
6AXC=<C hue: Number>▽<C saturation: Number>
6AXM=<M hue: Number>▽<M saturation: Number>
6AXY=<Y hue: Number>▽<Y saturation: Number>
Parameter Setting values for hue and color saturation (–20 to 20)
<Hue: Number>▽<Saturation: Number>
Number
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the 6-axis correction of the hue and color saturation for R to Y.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2
These commands take effect when 6-axis adjustment (6AX) has been selected by the
advanced color adjustment command (ACADJUST) or when they have been set to valid using
the 6-axis adjustment command (6AXADJ), and they can be set separately.
-3 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Advanced color adjustments] - [6-axis color adjustments]
SX6
SX60
X600
[Image adjustments] - [Advanced adjustments] - [6-axis color adjustments] -
[Adjustments]
-4 This sets the currently selected input signal and image mode.
-5 The current color adjustment values can be acquired using the applicable GET commands.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> 6AXR=-8, 5
The R hue is set to –8, and the color saturation is
set to 5.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET 6AXR or ?6AXR
This retrieves the R hue and color saturation.
<
g:6AXR=12, -8
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE 6AXC
< r:6AXC=N,-20,20,-20,20
Any value from -20 to 20 can be set for the hue
and saturation of the C (cyan) color.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command LAMP
1
LAMP
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
LAMP
Function Lamp output setting
LAMP=<Lamp output setting parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Lamp output setting parameters
Parameter Meaning
NORMAL Normal
SILENT Silent cooling
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to set the light quantity of the lamp to "NORMAL" or "SILENT" (reduced light
quantity appropriate for silent cooling).
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Image adjustments] - [Lamp mode]
SX6
SX60 [Image adjustments] - [Lamp mode]
X600
-3 The current lamp output can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> LAMP=NORMAL
< i:OK
The lamp output is set to “NORMAL”.
This retrieves the lamp output.
Reference
> GET LAMP or ?LAMP
<
g:LAMP=SILENT
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE LAMP
< r:LAMP=I, NORMAL, SILENT
"NORMAL" or "SILENT" can be set for the lamp output.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 46
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command RESET
1
RESET
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RESET
Function Reset
RESET□<Reset parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Reset parameters
Parameter Meaning
LAMPTIME Lamp on time reset
IMAGE Current image adjustment reset
SYSTEM Initial system settings
ID
ALL
Factory settings
Response An ‘i:OK’ is returned when the reset process is successful.
Furthermore, the internal status established when a response other than the normal response
("i:OK") has been returned is indeterminate.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This resets the projector settings.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2
What can be specified by the reset parameters for each "reset type" is provided below.
■ Reset of lamp on time
(a) The counter indicating the lamp replacement period is reset.
(b) This command is identical to the Reset function under Lamp counter in the System
settings menu.
(c) Execute this command after replacing the lamp.
■ Current image adjustment reset
(a) The adjustment settings of the currently-selected image mode are initialized.
(b) This command is identical to the Reset function in the Image adj. menu.
※
If there is an input signal, the image adjustment items are initialized and then the
adjustment values are optimized for the signal.
■ Reset of system settings
(a) The following items are initialized.
- Image adjustment items (all image modes)
- Initial settings executed
* For details, refer to 'RESET items' at the end of these specifications.
(b)
This command works in the same way as the menu [System settings] - [Initial settings]
function.
■ Factory settings
(a) The following items are initialized.
- Image adjustment items (all image modes)
- Initial settings executed
- Input source <-A-RGB2
- Language <- English
* For details, refer to 'RESET items' at the end of these specifications.
-3 Notes
(a) The power must never be turned off while this command is being executed!
(b) After the 'Factory settings,' be absolutely sure to turn the power off and then restart.
(c)
'NO_SIGNAL' may be returned as the response to the command after 'Current image
adjustment reset' or 'System initial setting' has been executed.
Example Control
RESET LAMPTIME
>
This resets the lamp on time.
< i:OK
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command VKS/HKS
1
VKS/HKS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
VKS/HKS
Function Vertical/Horizontal keystone setting
Format
VKS=<Vertical keystone distortion value: Number>
HKS=<Horizontal keystone distortion value: Number>
Parameter Vertical/horizontal keystone distortion values
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the vertical and horizontal keystones.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is identical to pressing the “KEYSTONE” button on the remote control or front pa
-3 The settable keystone range varies depending on the input signal, screen size, number of
horizontal and vertical dots, and other factors.
-4
Changing the vertical keystone value modifies the setting range of the horizontal keystone
value, and changing the horizontal keystone value modifies the setting range of the vertical
-5 Use the “RANGE” command to obtain the range of settable values immediately before setting
the vertical value and horizontal value.
-6 The GET command can be used to obtain the current vertical/horizontal keystone value.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> VKS=-23
This sets the vertical keystone to –23.
This sets the horizontal keystone to 10.
< i:OK
> HKS=10
< i:OK
Reference
> GET VKS or ?VKS
This retrieves the vertical keystone.
This retrieves the horizontal keystone.
<
g:VKS=-23
> GET HKS or ?HKS
< g:HKS=-23
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE HKS
< r:HKS=N,-30,30
Any value from -30 to 30 can be set for the horizontal
keystone distortion.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 48
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command AVOL
1
AVOL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
AVOL
Function Audio volume adjustment
Format
AVOL=<Audio volume level: Number>
Parameter Audio volume level (0 to 20)
The RANGE command can be used to obtain the parameter range that can be set at
that time.
Number
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This adjusts the volume.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The final beep sound setting is retained even when the power is turned off.
-3 This command has the same function as the buttons listed in the table below.
Model Button
SX50 'VOL+' and 'VOL-' on the remote control
SX6
SX60 'VOL' on the remote control
X600
-4 The volume level can be set even while the sound is muted, but the sound will remain muted.
-5 The GET command can be used to retrieve the current volume.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> AVOL=18
This sets the volume to 18.
This retrieves the volume.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET AVOL or ?AVOL
< g:AVOL=18
Obtain settable parameter range (Min, Max)
> RANGE AVOL
< r:AVOL=N,0,20
Any value from 0 to 20 can be set for the volume level.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command MUTE
1
MUTE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
MUTE
Function Mute control
Format
MUTE=<Mute control parameter: ID>
Parameter Mute control parameter
Parameter Meaning
ON
OFF
This turns off the audio/beep sound.
This returns the audio/beep sound to its original setting.
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to set the sound output muting to ON or OFF.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The mute setting is always "OFF" when the power has just been turned on.
-3 This command is identical to pressing the MUTE button on the remote control.
-4 Mute control enables simultaneous control of the audio and beep sound.
-5 The current muting status can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> MUTE=ON
This mutes the volume.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET MUTE or ?MUTE
This retrieves the volume state.
<
g:MUTE=ON
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE MUTE
r:MUTE=I, ON, OFF
<
"ON" or "OFF" can be set for muting control.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 50
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command BVOL
1
BVOL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
BVOL
Function BEEP sound setting
Format
BVOL=<Beep sound setting: Number>
Parameter Beep sound setting
Parameter Meaning
0
1
BEEP sound mute
BEEP sound output
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the BEEP sound output.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is identical to the Beep function in the System settings menu.
-3 The beep sound can be set even while the sound is muted, but it will not sound even if (beep
sound output) has been set.
-4 The current beep sound output status can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> BVOL=0
< i:OK
This mutes the BEEP sound.
Reference
> GET BVOL or ?BVOL
This retrieves the BEEP sound output state.
<
g:BVOL=1
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE BVOL
< r:BVOL=I, 0, 1
"0" or "1" can be selected as the beep sound setting.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command IMAGEFLIP
1
IMAGEFLIP
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
IMAGEFLIP
Function Flip display
IMAGEFLIP=<Image flip setting parameters :ID>
Format
Parameter Image flip setting parameters
Parameter
Meaning
None
Ceiling
Rear
Remarks
Flip horizontally
NONE
CEILING
REAR
Flip vertically
ID
Flip horizontally and vertically
REAR_CEILING Rear ceiling
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to flip the screen display in various ways (vertically or horizontally).
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [Flip display]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [Flip display]
X600
-3
When the display is flipped, the "keystone distortion" settings are initialized (set to HKS:0,
VKS:0).
-4 The current flip display status can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> IMAGEFLIP=REAR
This displays the image backwards (flip
vertically) on the screen.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET IMAGEFLIP or ?IMAGEFLIP
This retrieves the flip display state.
< g:IMAGEFLIP=REAR_CEILING
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE IMAGEFLIP
<
r:IMAGEFLIP=I,NONE,CEILING,REAR,REAR_CEILING
"NONE," "CEILING," "REAR" or "REAR
CEILING" can be selected as the flip
display setting.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 52
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command PMM
1
PMM
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
PMM
Function Power management
PMM=<Power management setting parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Power management setting parameters
Parameter
Meaning
OFF
STANDBY
EXIT
OFF
Standby mode
Exit mode
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets Power management mode.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [System settings] - [Power management modes]
SX6
SX60 [System settings] - [Power management modes]
X600
-2
-3
With the SX6, SX60 or X600, power management cannot be set to OFF if ON has been
selected as the direct power-on setting (DPON=ON). ("e:1005 DIRECT_POWER_ON" is
The projector behaves as follows with the power management setting and in the remote mode.
Model Projector behavior
In the remote mode, the power management setting is ignored.
This setting takes effect only when the local mode is established.
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
Even in the remote mode, the projector operates as per the power management
setting.
However, when it starts operating, it is automatically transferred to the "local
mode."
-4 The current power management mode can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> PMM=STANDBY
This sets the power management to "standby."
This retrieves the Power management mode.
< i:OK
Reference
>
GET PMM or ?PMM
< g:PMM=EXIT
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE PMM
< r:PMM=I, OFF, STANDBY, EXIT "OFF," "STANDBY" or "EXIT" can be set for the power
management.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command PJON
1
PJON
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
PJON
Function Display screen at startup setting
PJON=<Parameters for setting display screen at startup;ID>
Format
Parameter Parameters for setting display screen at startup
Parameter Meaning
CANON Canon logo
SKIP
No display
LOGO User screen
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the screen displayed at startup.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [User screen settings] - [Screen at startup]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [User screen settings] - [Screen at startup]
X600
-3
To select the user screen (LOGO), the user image must be registered ahead of time. (If the
user image is not registered, "e:1002 NO_LOGO_CAPTURED" is returned.)
-4 The GET command can be used to obtain the current screen displayed at startup.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> PJON=CANON
This sets the startup screen to “Canon logo”.
This retrieves the startup screen.
< i:OK
Reference
>
GET PJON or ?PJON
< g:PJON=SKIP
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE PJON
"CANON," "SKIP" or "LOGO" can be set for the display
screen at startup.
< r:PJON=I, CANON, SKIP, LOGO
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 54
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command NOSIG
1
NOSIG
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
NOSIG
Function Display screen when no signal setting
NOSIG=<Parameters for setting display screen in no-signal mode:ID>
Format
Parameter Parameters for setting display screen in no-signal mode
Parameter Meaning
BLACK Black screen
BLUE Blue screen
LOGO User screen
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the display screen when no image signals are input.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [User screen settings] - [Screen in no-signal mode]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [User screen settings] - [Screen in no-signal mode]
X600
-3
To select the user screen (LOGO), the user image must be registered ahead of time. (If the
user image is not registered, "e:1002 NO_LOGO_CAPTURED" is returned.)
-4 The GET command can be used to obtain the current display screen at no signal.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> NOSIG=BLUE
This sets the “Blue” screen when no signals are input.
This retrieves the screen when no signals are input.
< i:Ok
Reference
>
GET NOSIG or ?NOSIG
< g:NOSIG=LOGO
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE NOSIG
< r:NOSIG=I, BLACK, BLUE, LOGO "BLACK," "BLUE" or "LOGO" can be set for the display
screen in the no-signal mode.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command NOSHOW
1
NOSHOW
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
NOSHOW
Function Display screen setting when nothing shown
NOSHOW=<Parameters for setting display screen in no show status :ID>
Format
Parameter Parameters for setting display screen in no show status
Parameter Meaning
BLACK Black screen
BLUE Blue screen
LOGO User screen
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to set the screen which is to appear in the no show status.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [User screen settings] - [Screen in no show status]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [User screen settings] - [Screen in no show status]
X600
-3
To select the user screen (LOGO), the user image must be registered ahead of time. (If the
user image is not registered, "e:1002 NO_LOGO_CAPTURED" is returned.)
-4 The GET command can be used to obtain the current display screen when nothing is shown.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> NOSHOW=LOGO
This sets the “User” screen when nothing is displayed.
This retrieves the screen shown when nothing is displayed.
< Ok
Reference
>
GET NOSHOW or ?NOSHOW
< g:NOSHOW=LOGO
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE NOSHOW
< r:NOSHOW=BLACK,BLUE,LOGO
"BLACK," "BLUE" or "LOGO" can be set for the display
screen in the no show status.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 56
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9. Details of command LOGOPOS
User Command Specifications
1
LOGOPOS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
LOGOPOS
Function User image position setting
LOGOPOS=<User image position setting parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter User image position setting parameters
Parameter
Meaning
Upper left
Upper right
Center
UPPER_L
UPPER_R
CENTER
LOWER_L
LOWER_R
Lower left
Lower right
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the logo display position.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [Display settings] - [User screen settings] - [User image position]
SX6
SX60 [Display settings] - [User screen settings] - [User image position]
X600
-3
This setting cannot be made unless the user screen is registered beforehand.
(Error "e:1002 NO_LOGO_CAPTURED" is returned.)
-4 The current display position can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> LOGOPOS=UPPER_R
< i:OK
This sets the logo display position to the upper right.
This retrieves the logo display position.
Reference
> GET LOGOPOS or ?LOGOPOS
< g:LOGOPOS=LOWER_L
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE LOGOPOS
< r:LOGOPOS=I,UPPER_L,UPPER_R,CENTER,LOWER_L,LOWER_R
"UPPER_L," "UPPER_R,"
"CENTER," "LOWER_L" or
"LOWER_R" can be set as the
user image position.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9. Details of command LANG
User Command Specifications
1
LANG
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
LANG
Function Language select
LANG=<Language selection parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Language selection parameters
Errors supported by model
Parameter
Meaning
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
ENG
FRA
GER
ITA
English
French
German
Italian
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
SPA
POR
SWE
DUT
RUS
CHS
CHT
KOR
JPN
FIN
NOR
TUR
POL
HUN
CZE
DAN
Spanish
Portuguese
Swedish
Dutch
Russian
Chinese (simplified)
Chinese (traditional)
Korean
Japanese
Finnish
Norwegian
Turkish
Polish
ID
Hungarian
Czech
Danish
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This switches the screen display language.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
SX50 [System settings] - [Languages]
SX6
SX60 [System settings] - [Languages]
X600
-3 The currently set language can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> LANG=SWE
This sets the display language to “Swedish”.
This retrieves the language.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET LANG or ?LANG
< g:LANG=SWE
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE LANG
<
r:LANG=I,ENG,FRA,GER,ITA,SPA,POR,SWE,DUT,RUS,CHS,CHT,KOR,JPN,FIN,NOR,TUR,
POL,HUN,CZE,DAN
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 58
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command TERMINAL
1
TERMINAL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
TERMINAL
Function Terminal setting
TERMINAL=<Terminal setting parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Terminal setting parameters
Parameter Meaning
IN
OUT
This sets to input
This sets to output
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This sets the input/output of the RGB-IN2/COMPONENT IN/RGB OUT terminals.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
-2 This command is identical to the Terminal command in the System settings menu.
-3
The “OUT” (output) setting cannot be made when the “A-RGB2” or “COMP” input is selected!
-4 The current terminal setting can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> TERMINAL=IN
This sets to input
< i:OK
Reference
> GET TERMINAL or ?TERMINAL
< g:TERMINAL=OUT
This retrieves the terminal setting state.
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE TERMINAL
< r:TERMINAL=I, IN, OUT
"IN" or "OUT" can be selected as the terminal setting.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
×
SX60
01.01**
×
X600
01.01**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Parameter
Power
Input
Mode
OFF ON PM
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
IN
SX50
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
OUT
×
×
SX6
SX60
X600
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'TERMINAL_OUT' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command KEYLOCK
1
KEYLOCK
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
KEYLOCK
Function Keylock setting
KEYLOCK=<Key lock setting parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Key lock setting parameters
Parameter Meaning
OFF
MAIN
RC
No locking (OFF)
Main key lock
Remote control key lock
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to lock the keys so as to restrict the operations performed using the remote
control or main unit.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is the same as the menu functions in the table below.
Model Menu
[System settings] - [Key lock]
SX50
SX6
SX60 [System settings] - [Key lock]
X600
-3
This command will not affect the emulation function (remote control or main unit commands)
even if the main unit or remote control keys are locked!
-4 The current key lock setting can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> KEYLOCK=RC
This locks the remote control keys.
This retrieves the key lock state.
< i:OK
Reference
> GET KEYLOCK or ?KEYLOCK
< g:KEYLOCK=OFF
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE KEYLOCK
< r:KEYLOCK=I,OFF,MAIN,RC
"OFF," "MAIN" or "RC" can be selected as the key
lock setting.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 60
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command RCCH
1
RCCH
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RCCH
Function Remote control setting
RCCH=<Remote control setting parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Remote control setting parameters
Parameter Meaning
1
2
Remote control channel 1
Remote control channel 2
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to set the channel of the remote control used at the projector end to 1 or 2.
-1 It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the
same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 This command is identical to the Remote control function in the System settings menu.
Model Menu
SX50 [System settings] - [Remote control]
SX6
SX60 [System settings] - [Other settings] - [Remote control]
X600
-3 The current remote control setting can be acquired using the applicable GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Example Setting
> RCCH=1
< i:OK
This sets the remote control channel to ch1.
This retrieves the remote control setting state.
Reference
> GET RCCH or ?RCCH
< g:RCCH=2
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE RCCH
< r:RCCH=I, 1, 2
"1" or "2" can be set as the remote control channel.
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 61
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command GUID
1
GUIDE
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
GUIDE
Function Guide setting
Format
GUIDE=<Guide setting parameter:ID>
Parameter Guide setting parameters
Parameter Meaning
ON
OFF
Guide display ON
Guide display OFF
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to set the guide function display to ON or OFF.
(1)
It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
This command functions in the same way as when "System settings" - "Guide" are selected on the
menu.
)
(2)
(3)
However, the guide is cleared immediately when "GUIDE=OFF" is received while the guide is displayed.
The current guide setting can be obtained using the GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Setting
Example
> GUIDE=ON
< i:OK
The guide display is set to ON.
Reference
> GET GUIDE or ?GUIDE
< g:GUIDE=ON
The guide display setting status is obtained.
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE GUIDE
< r:GUIDE=I, OFF, ON
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 62
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command DPON
1
DPON
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
DPON
Function Direct power-on setting
Format
DPON=<Direct power-on setting parameter:ID>
Parameter Direct power-on setting parameters
Parameter Meaning
ON
OFF
This sets direct power-on to ON.
This sets direct power-on to OFF.
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to set direct power-on function to ON or OFF.
(1)
It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
(2) This command functions in the same way as when "System settings" - "Direct power-on" are
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
selected on the menu.
(3) Direct power-on cannot be set to ON when "OFF" has been selected as the power management
setting.
("e:1004 POWER_MANAGEMENT_OFF" is returned.)
The current direct power-on setting can be obtained using the GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
(5)
Setting
Example
> DPON=ON
< i:OK
Direct power-on is set to ON.
Reference
> GET DPON or ?DPON
The current direct power-on setting is obtained.
<
g:DPON=ON
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE DPON
< r:DPON=I,ON,OFF
"ON" or "OFF" can be set for direct power-on.
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
Commands
supported 01.00**
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command LEDILLUMINATE
1
LEDILLUMINATE
Commands
Reference
Mode Control Setting
LEDILLUMINATE
Function Emotional LED and signal sensing LED lighting control
Format LEDILLUMINATE=<LED lighting control setting parameter:ID>
Parameter LED lighting control setting parameters
Parameter Meaning
ON
OFF
This sets the LED display to ON.
This sets the LED display to OFF.
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned if the parameter was set properly.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to control the lighting of the emotional LED and signal sensing LED.
(1)
It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
(3)
This command functions in the same way as when "System settings" - "LED illumination" are
selected on the menu.
The current LED illumination setting can be obtained using the GET command.
For details, refer to the GET command.
Setting
Example
>
<
LEDILLUMINATE=ON
i:OK
The LED display is set to ON.
Reference
> GET LEDILLUMINATE or ?LEDILLUMINATE
The ON or OFF setting for the LED display is
obtained.
<
g:LEDILLUMINATE=ON
Acquisition of parameters which can be set
> RANGE LEDILLUMINATE
< r:LEDILLUMINATE=I, ON, OFF
"ON" or "OFF" can be set for the LED display.
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
Commands
supported 01.00**
SX6
SX60
X600
01.01**
01.01**
01.01**
○
○
○
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 64
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command ZSTEPDRV
1
ZSTEPDRV
Commands
Reference
Mode Control Setting
ZSTEPDRV
Function Zoom lens step drive control
Format
ZSTEPDRV=<Zoom lens step control parameter:ID>
Parameter Zoom lens step control parameters
Parameter Meaning
WIDE
TELE
This zooms to the wide-angle end.
This zooms to the telephoto end.
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned when zooming was completed successfully after step drive.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to initiate the step drive of the zoom lens.
(1)
It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
This command functions in the same way as when first the "ZOOM" button on the remote control or
main unit panel is pressed and then the "←" or "→" button is pressed.
The amount by which the lens is zoomed is constant, and it is fixed in the system.
If a zooming error occurs, step drive cannot be controlled.
(3)
(4)
Control
Example
> ZSTEPDRV=TELE
< I:OK
1-step control is exercised over the zoom toward the TELE end.
Range acquisition
> RANGE ZSTEPDRV
< r:ZSTEPDRV=I, WIDE, TELE
"WIDE" or "TELE" can be set as the step control of the zoom.
SX50
Commands
supported 01.00**
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 65
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command ZCONTDRV
1
ZCONTDRV
Commands
Reference
Mode Control Setting
ZCONTDRV
Function Zoom lens continuous drive control
Format
ZCONTDRV=<Zoom lens continuous control parameter:ID>
Parameter Zoom lens continuous control parameters
Parameter Meaning
STOP
WIDE
TELE
This stops the zooming.
This zooms to the wide-angle end.
This zooms to the telephoto end.
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned when the drive was completed successfully.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to drive the zoom lens continuously.
(1) It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, only the "STOP" parameter takes effect while the zoom lens is being driven, and a "busy"
response is given while the focus lens is being driven.
(
)
Refer to the FCONTDRV command.
(2) This command functions in the same way as when first the "ZOOM" button on the remote control or
main unit panel is pressed and then the "↑" or "↓" button is pressed.
(3) Zoom drive is started by specifying "TELE" or "WIDE." To stop the drive, add the "STOP"
parameter and send this command.
If no instruction was given to stop the drive, the drive stops at the drive direction end.
(4) The following commands are acknowledged during zoom drive, but zoom drive will also stop at the
same time.
▼
In the case of any other commands, "i:BUSY (ZOOM)" is returned unconditionally, and zoom drive
continues.
a. REMOTE
b. LOCAL
c. POWER
d. ZCONTDRV=STOP
(5) The following commands are acknowledged during zoom drive, and a response is returned while the
drive continues.
a. GET MODE
e. GET PRODCODE
f. GET ROMVER
g. GET COMVER
b. GET POWER
c. GET ERR
d. GET LAMPCOUNTER
(6)
Zoom drive stops when the "POWER" button on the remote control or main unit panel is pressed
during zoom drive.
Example Control
> ZCONTDRV=TELE
< I:OK
Control over the zooming to the telephoto end is started.
Range acquisition
> RANGE ZCONTDRV
< r:ZCONTDRV = I, STOP, WIDE, TELE
"STOP," "WIDE" or "TELE" can be set for zoom lens
continuous drive.
SX50
Commands
supported 01.00**
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 66
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command FSTEPDRV
1
FSTEPDRV
Commands
Reference
Mode Control Setting
FSTEPDRV
Function Focus lens step drive control
Format
FSTEPDRV=<Focus lens step control parameter:ID>
Parameter Focus lens step control parameters
Parameter Meaning
FAR
NEAR
This initiates focusing toward the far end.
This initiates focusing toward the near end.
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned when zooming was completed successfully after step drive.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to drive the focus lens.
(1) It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
This command functions in the same way as when first the "FOCUS" button on the remote control
or main unit panel is pressed and then the "←" or "→" button is pressed.
The amount by which the lens is focused is constant, and it is fixed for the system.
If a focusing error occurs, step drive cannot be controlled.
(3)
(4)
Control
Example
> FSTEPDRV=NEAR
< I:OK
1-step control is exercised over the zoom toward the
NEAR end.
Range acquisition
> RANGE FSTEPDRV
< r:FSTEPDRV=I, FAR, NEAR
"FAR" or "NEAR" can be set for focus step control.
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 67
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command FCONTDRV
1
FCONTDRV
Commands
Reference
Mode Control Setting
FCONTDRV
Function Focus lens continuous drive control
Format
FCONTDRV=<Focus lens continuous control parameter:ID>
Parameter Focus lens continuous control parameters
Parameter Meaning
STOP
FAR
NEAR
This stops the focusing.
This initiates focusing toward the far end.
This initiates focusing toward the near end.
ID
The parameters which can be set at any given point in time can be obtained using the
RANGE command.
For details, refer to the RANGE command.
Response "i:OK" is returned when the drive was completed successfully.
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to drive the focus lens.
(1)
It can be executed when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at the same
time.
However, only the "STOP" parameter takes effect while the focus lens is being driven, and a "busy"
response is given while the zoom lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
This command functions in the same way as when first the "FOCUS" button on the remote control
or main unit panel is pressed and then the "↑" or "↓" button is pressed.
(3) Focus drive is started by specifying "NEAR" or "FAR." To stop the drive, add the "STOP"
parameter and send this command.
If no instruction was given to stop the drive, the drive stops at the drive direction end.
(4) The following commands are acknowledged during focus drive, but focus drive will also stop at the
same time.
▼
In the case of any other commands, "i:BUSY (FOCUS)" is returned unconditionally, and focus drive
continues.
a. REMOTE
b. LOCAL
c. POWER
d. FCONTDRV=STOP
(5) The following commands are acknowledged during focus drive, and a response is returned while the
drive continues.
a. GET MODE
e. GET PRODCODE
f. GET ROMVER
g. GET COMVER
b. GET POWER
c. GET ERR
d. GET LAMPCOUNTER
(6)
Focus drive stops when the "POWER" button on the remote control or main unit panel is pressed
during focus drive.
Example Control
> FCONTDRV=NEAR
< I:OK
Control over the focusing to the near end is started.
Range acquisition
> RANGE FCONTDRV
< r:FCONTDRV=I, STOP, FAR, NEAR
"STOP," "FAR" or "NEAR" can be set for focus
lens continuous drive.
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:0002 INVALID_COMMAND" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 68
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command RC
2
RC
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RC
Function Remote control operation emulate
RC□<Remote control emulation button parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Remote control emulation button parameters
The key assignment for the remote control emulation buttons is as follows.
Remote control
button
Errors supported by model
Parameter
POWER
Remarks
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
POWER
○
○
○
○
○
POWER button
pressed twice
-
POWER_OFF
○
○
○
MENU
AUTO SET
COMPUTER1
COMPUTER2
VIDEO
MENU
AUTOSET
COMPUTER1
COMPUTER2
VIDEO
○
×
○
○
○
×
○
○
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
INPUT
INPUT
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
AUTOPC
KEYSTONE
AUTOPC
KEYSTONE
UP
UP+REP
DOWN
DOWN+REP
LEFT
LEFT+REP
RIGHT
RIGHT+REP
OK
R_CLICK
P_UP
P_UP+REP
P_DOWN
P_DOWN+REP
IMAGE
○
○
○
×
○
×
○
×
○
×
○
○
○
×
○
×
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
×
UP
Button press start
Button press start
Button press start
Button press start
DOWN
LEFT
RIGHT
ID
OK
R_CLICK
PAGE ▲
PAGE ▼
Button press start
Button press start
IMAGE
FREEZE
VOL +
VOL -
VOL
NOSHOW
MUTE
P-TIMER
FREEZE
VOL_P
VOL_M
VOL
NOSHOW
MUTE
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
P_TIMER
DZOOM_P
DZOOM_P+REP
DZOOM_M
DZOOM_M+REP
SPOT
DZOOM +
Button press start
Button press start
○
×
○
×
×
×
DZOOM_M
SPOT
FOCUS
ZOOM
-
FOCUS
ZOOM
*-REP
Button press end
*Use the application to adjust the time between pressing of keys.
PAGE 69
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command RC
Response "i:OK" is returned when the button press request has been acknowledged successfully.
(It does not indicate if the operation for the pressed button was executed properly.)
Description This emulates pressing of the remote control buttons for controlling the projector.
-1 It can only be used during Local mode.
■ Note 1
With the emulation of the remote control operations, the functions of the buttons corresponding
to the parameters cannot necessarily be executed.
Emulation simply consists in emulating the pressing of the buttons.
■ Note 2
The following functions are unavailable in remote control emulation.
- USB mouse function
- Function for transfer to special mode (service mode)
■ Note 3
A parameter with '+REP' signifies "button press start." (This is the same as the status in which
the remote control button is held down.)
Be absolutely sure to send the '*-REP' parameter, and end the button pressing last of all.
The button pressing is ended in the cases below as well.
<1> When a panel or remote control button has been operated
<2> When an 'RC' or 'MAIN' command has been received
<3> When operation has transferred to the remote mode
Example Setting
> RC POWER
< i:Ok
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
×
×
○
○
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' is returned as an error response.
PAGE 70
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command MAIN
1
MAIN
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
MAIN
Function Front panel operation emulation
MAIN□<Main unit panel emulation button parameters:ID>
Format
Parameter Main unit panel emulation button parameters
The key assignments for the front panel buttons are shown below.
Remote control
button
Errors supported by model
Parameter
POWER
Remarks
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
POWER
○
○
○
○
○
POWER button
pressed twice
–
POWER_OFF
○
○
○
MENU
AUTO SET
COMPUTER1
COMPUTER2
VIDEO
INPUT
AUTOPC
KEYSTONE
MENU
AUTOSET
COMPUTER1
COMPUTER2
VIDEO
○
×
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
×
○
×
○
×
○
×
○
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
INPUT
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
AUTOPC
KEYSTONE
UP
UP+REP
DOWN
DOWN+REP
LEFT
LEFT+REP
RIGHT
RIGHT+REP
OK
FOCUS
ZOOM
*-REP
ID
UP
Button press start
Button press start
Button press start
Button press start
DOWN
LEFT
RIGHT
OK
FOCUS
ZOOM
–
Button press end
×
*Use the application to adjust the time between pressing of keys.
Response "i:OK" is returned when the button press request has been acknowledged successfully.
(It does not indicate if the operation for the pressed button was executed properly.)
Description This emulates the pressing of the front panel buttons for controlling the projector.
-1 It can only be used during Local mode.
■ Note 1
With the emulation of the front panel operations, the functions of the buttons corresponding to
the parameters cannot necessarily be executed. Emulation simply consists in emulating the
pressing of the buttons.
■ Note 2
A parameter with '+REP' signifies "button press start." (This is the same as the status in which
the front panel button is held down.)
Be absolutely sure to send the '*-REP' parameter, and end the button pressing last of all.
The button pressing is ended in the cases below as well.
<1> When a panel or remote control button has been operated
<2> When an 'RC' or 'MAIN' command has been received
<3> When operation has transferred to the remote mode
Example Setting
> MAIN FOCUS
< i:OK
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
×
×
○
○
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' is returned as an error response.
PAGE 71
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET
User Command Specifications
1
GET
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET
Function Retrieve each data
GET□ <Parameter>
Format
?△<Parameter>
Parameter
Parameter
MODE
POWER
BLANK
INPUT
DOTS
TRACK
HPOS
VPOS
Meaning
Mode
Power supply state
BLANK status
Input state
Total dot number
Tracking
Horizontal position
Vertical position
Horizontal resolution
Vertical resolution
Input
signal
settings
HPIX
VPIX
SEL
Input signal
Screen size
Image settings
ASPECT
IMAGE
BRI
Brightness setting
CONT
Contrast setting
SHARP
GAMMA
DGAMMA
PROG
Sharpness setting
Gamma correction
Dynamic gamma
Progressive
WB
WBRGB
SAT
Screen color correction methods
Screen color correction (RGB)
Color saturation setting
Hue setting
HUE
RGBGAIN
RGBOFFSET
ACADJUST
MEMCADJ
6AXADJ
6AXR
RGB gain adjustment
RGB offset adjustment
Advanced color adjustment methods
Memory color correction
6-axis adjustment ON/OFF
R Setting
6AXG
6AXB
6AXC
6AXM
G Setting
ID
6-axis
B Setting
color
C Setting
adjust
M Setting
6AXY
Y Setting
VKS
HKS
AVOL
Vertical keystone distortion values
Horizontal keystone distortion values
Volume adjustment
MUTE
Mute status
BVOL
IMAGEFLIP
PMM
Beep sound setting status
Flip display status
Power management
PJON
Display screen at startup setting
NOSIG
NOSHOW
LOGOPOS
LANG
Display screen when there are no signals setting
Display screen when nothing shown
User image position
Language
LAMP
Lamp output
TERMINAL
KEYLOCK
RCCH
Terminal setting
Key lock
Remote control Ch
GUIDE
DPON
Guide display setting
Direct power-on setting
LEDILLUMINATE LED display setting
NOSHOWSTATE No show status
FREEZE
Freeze status
SIGNALSTATUS Signal status detection
LAMPCOUNTER Lamp on time
ERR
Error information
Production code
ROM version
PRODCODE
ROMVER
COMVER
User command version
PAGE 72
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET MODE
User Command Specifications
1
GET MODE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET MODE
Function Current control mode inquiry
Format
GET□MODE
?△MODE
Response
g:MODE=<Mode:ID>
Mode
Meaning
LOCAL The local mode is currently established.
REMOTE The remote mode is currently established.
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current control mode.
-1 For details on the control modes of the user commands, refer to the control mode.
-2 This inquiry can be executed in any status provided that AC power is supplied to the projector.
-3 The control mode is usually switched by REMOTE command-LOCAL command, but when the next
event occurs in the remote status, the mode is switched to the local status.
a. When the POWER button on the remote control or main unit panel has been pressed twice
(power off operation)
b. When the power management mode has been established (standby, power off)
Example > GET MODE or ?MODE
< g:MODE=REMOTE
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
○
○
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
PAGE 73
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET POWER
1
GET POWER
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET POWER
Function Power status inquiry
GET□POWER
?△POWER
Format
Response
g:POWER=<Power status: ID>
Power supply state
Status
OFF
Power Off
Transitioning from power off→on
Power on
OFF2ON
ON
ON2PMM
PMM
Transitioning from power on→standby mode
Standby
ID
PMM2ON
ON2OFF
Transitioning from standby→power on
Transitioning from power on→off
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current projector power status.
-1 This inquiry can be executed in any status provided that AC power is supplied to the projector.
For the "SX50," the remote mode must be established.
-2 Use the following commands to control the power status with the user commands.
Mode
Local
Commands
RC POWER/POWER_OFF
MAIN POWER/POWER_OFF
POWER ON/OFF
Remote
Example > GET POWER or ?POWER
< g:POWER=ON
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' is returned as an error response.
PAGE 74
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET BLANK
1
GET BLANK
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
GET BLANK
Function BLANK status inquiry
Format
GET□BLANK
?△BLANK
Response
g:BLANK=<BLANK status:ID>
BLANK status
Status
ON
OFF
BLANK underway
BLANK release underway
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire about the current BLANK status.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
The BLANK setting can be controlled using the BLANK command.
)
(2)
>
<
Example
GET BLANK or ? BLANK
g:BLANK=ON
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
-
-
○
-
○
-
×
○
○
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 75
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET INPUT
User Command Specifications
1
GET INPUT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET INPUT
Function Input selection inquiry
GET□INPUT
?△INPUT
Format
Response
g:INPUT=<Input type: ID>
Errors supported by model
Input type Meaning
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
D-RGB D-RGB
A-RGB1 A-RGB1
A-RGB2 A-RGB2
COMP Component
VIDEO Video
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
ID
S-VIDEO S-Video
D-VIDEO Digital Video
SCARTRGB
SCART(RGB)
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current input selection.
This inquiry can be made in the power-on status.
×
-1
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With the SX50, the inquiry can be made in the remote mode only.
-2 The input selection can be controlled by the INPUT command.
Example > GET INPUT or ? INPUT
< g:INPUT=VIDEO
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 76
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET DOTS
User Command Specifications
1
GET DOTS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET DOTS
Function Total number of dots inquiry
GET□DOTS
?△DOTS
Format
Response
g:DOTS=<Total number of dots: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current total number of dots.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2 The total number of dots can be set by the DOTS command.
Example > GET DOTS or ? DOTS
< g:DOTS=1200
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 77
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET TRACK
User Command Specifications
1
GET TRACK
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET TRACK
Function Tracking adjustment value inquiry
GET□TRACK
?△TRACK
Format
Response
g:TRACK=<Tracking adjustment value: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current tracking adjustment value.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2 The tracking adjustment can be set by the TRACK command.
Example > GET TRACK or ? TRACK
< g:TRACK=21
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 78
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET HPOS/VPOS
User Command Specifications
1
GET HPOS/VPOS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET HPOS/VPOS
Function Horizontal and vertical position adjustment inquiries
Format
Horizontal position adjustment inquiry Vertical position adjustment inquiry
GET□HPOS
?△HPOS
GET□VPOS
?△VPOS
Response
g:HPOS=<Horizontal position adjustment value: Number>
g:VPOS=<Vertical position adjustment value: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description These inquire about the current horizontal and vertical position adjustment values.
-1 This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2
The horizontal and vertical position adjustments can be set using the HPOS and VPOS commands,
respectively.
Example > GET VPOS or ? VPOS
< g:VPOS=8
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 79
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET HPIX/VPIX
User Command Specifications
1
GET HPIX/VPIX
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET HPIX/VPIX
Function Horizontal and vertical resolution inquiries
Format
Horizontal resolution inquiry
GET□HPIX
Vertical resolution inquiry
GET□VPIX
?△HPIX
?△VPIX
Response
g:HPIX=<Horizontal resolution: Number>
g:VPIX=<Vertical resolution: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description These inquire about the current horizontal and vertical resolutions.
-1
-2
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
The horizontal and vertical resolutions can be set using the HPIX and VPIX commands,
respectively.
Example > GET VPIX or ? VPIX
< g:VPIX=684
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 80
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET SEL
User Command Specifications
1
GET SEL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET SEL
Function Input signal inquiry
GET□SEL
?△SEL
Format
Response
g:SEL=<Input signal: ID>
Input signal
Remarks
PAL
PAL-M,PAL-N included
SECAM
NTSC NTSC4.43 included
1080i
1035i
540p (1080i non-interlaced signals) included
720p
575p
ID
480p
575i
480i
UNKNOWN
288p (PAL system non-interlaced signals) included
240p (NTSC system non-interlaced signals) included
No-color, 1080p, and other signals
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current input signals.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2 The input signals can be selected by the SEL command.
Example > GET SEL or ? SEL
< g:SEL=575p
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 81
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET ASPECT
User Command Specifications
1
GET ASPECT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET ASPECT
Function Screen setting inquiry
GET□ASPECT
?△ASPECT
Format
Response
g:ASPECT=<Screen setting:ID>
Errors supported by model
Parameter Meaning
AUTO Auto
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
○
○
○
○
–
○
○
○
○
–
○
○
○
NORMAL
WIDE
Normal
Wide
ID
FULL
TRUE
Full screen
Real
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current screen setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2 The screen settings can be selected by the ASPECT command.
Example > GET ASPECT or ? ASPECT
< g:ASPECT=TRUE
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 82
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET IMAGE
User Command Specifications
1
GET IMAGE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET IMAGE
Function Image mode inquiry
GET□IMAGE
?△IMAGE
Format
Response
g:IMAGE=<Image mode:ID>
Errors supported by model
Parameter
Meaning
Standard
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
×
○
○
×
○
○
×
○
×
○
○
×
○
×
○
×
×
STANDARD
PRESENTATION Presentation
CINEMA
SRGB
ADOBE
MOVIE
Cinema
sRGB
ADOBE RGB
Movie
ID
○
MOVIE_PHOTO Movie & Photo
HOME_CINEMA Home theater
○
×
×
○
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current image mode.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The image mode settings can be selected by the IMAGE command.
Example > GET IMAGE or ? IMAGE
< g:IMAGE=CINEMA
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 83
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET BRI
User Command Specifications
1
GET BRI
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET BRI
Function Brightness value setting inquiry
GET□BRI
?△BRI
Format
Response
g:BRI=<Brightness:Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current brightness value setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The brightness can be set by the BRI command.
Example > GET BRI or ? BRI
< g:BRI=-10
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 84
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET CONT
User Command Specifications
1
GET CONT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET CONT
Function Contrast value setting inquiry
GET□CONT
?△CONT
Format
Response
g:CONT=<Contrast value: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current contrast value setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The contrast can be set by the CONT command.
Example > GET CONT or ? CONT
< g:CONT=3
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 85
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET SHARP
1
GET SHARP
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET SHARP
Function Sharpness value setting inquiry
GET□SHARP
?△ SHARP
Format
Response
g;SHARP=<Sharpness setting: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current sharpness value setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The sharpness can be set by the SHARP command.
Example > GET SHARP or ? SHARP
< g:SHARP=3
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.01**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 86
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET GAMMA
User Command Specifications
1
GET GAMMA
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET GAMMA
Function Gamma adjustment value inquiry
GET□GAMMA
?△GAMMA
Format
Response
g:GAMMA=<Gamma adjustment value:Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current gamma adjustment value.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The gamma adjustment value can be set by the GAMMA command.
Example > GET GAMMA or ? GAMMA
< g:GAMMA=3
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 87
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET DGAMMA
User Command Specifications
1
GET DGAMMA
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET DGAMMA
Function Dynamic gamma value setting inquiry
GET□DGAMMA
?△DGAMMA
Format
Response
g:DGAMMA=<Setting: ID>
Setting Meaning
0
1
Off
On
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current dynamic gamma value setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The dynamic gamma setting value can be selected by the DGAMMA command.
Example > GET DGAMMA or ? DGAMMA
< g:DGAMMA=1
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 88
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET PROG
User Command Specifications
1
GET PROG
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET PROG
Function Progressive value setting inquiry
GET□PROG
?△PROG
Format
Response
g:PROG=<Set (status) value: ID>
Errors supported by model
Response
Meaning
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
0
1
2
Off
On
AUTO
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current progressive (status) value set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2 The significance of the response differs slightly depending on the model concerned.
Model Significance of response
Regardless of the progressive setting, "ON" is indicated when the current
SX50
progressive conversion processing function is working; "OFF" is indicated when the
processing function is not working.
SX6
SX60
X600
This signifies the progressive value setting.
-3 The progressive setting can be selected by the PROG command.
Example > GET PROG or ? PROG
< g:PROG=1
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 89
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET WB
User Command Specifications
1
GET WB
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET WB
Function Screen color correction inquiry
GET□WB
?△WB
Format
Response
g:WB=<Screen color correction value: ID>
Response
Meaning
Normal
NORMAL
GREENBOARD
ADJUST
Blackboard
Adjust
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current screen color correction.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The screen color correction can be set by the WB command.
Example > GET WB or ? WB
< g:WB=GREENBOARD
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 90
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET WBRGB
User Command Specifications
1
GET WBRGB
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET WBRGB
Function Screen color correction (adjustment) inquiry
GET□WBRGB
?△WBRGB
Format
Response
g:WBRGB=<R adjustment value: Number>▽<G adjustment value: Number>▽<B
adjustment value: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current screen color correction (adjustment).
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The screen color correction (adjustment) can be set by the WBRGB command.
Example > GET WBRGB or ? WBRGB
< g:WBRGB=10, 0, 19
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 91
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET SAT
User Command Specifications
1
GET SAT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET SAT
Function Color saturation value setting inquiry
GET□SAT
?△SAT
Format
Response
g:SAT=<Color saturation value setting: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current color saturation value setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2 The color saturation can be set by the SAT command.
Example > GET SAT or ? SAT
< g:SAT=1
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01*
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
×
–
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 92
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET HUE
User Command Specifications
1
GET HUE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET HUE
Function Hue value setting inquiry
GET□HUE
?△HUE
Format
Response
g:HUE=<Hue value setting:Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current hue value set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2 The hue can be set by the HUE command.
Example > GET HUE or ? HUE
< g:HUE=1
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
–
–
○
–
–
○
–
○
×
SX50
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
–
–
○
×
SX6
SX60
X600
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
○
×
–
○
○
×
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 93
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET RGBGAIN
1
GET RGBGAIN
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
GET RGBGAIN
Function RGB gain adjustment value inquiry
Format
GET□RGBGAIN
?△RGBGAIN
g:RGBGAIN=<R adjustment value:Number>▽<G adjustment value:Number>▽<B
adjustment value:Number>
Response
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire about the current RGB gain adjustment values.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
The RGB gain can be set using the RGBGAIN command.
)
(2)
Example > GET RGBGAIN or ? RGBGAIN
< g:RGBGAIN=-10, 0, 19
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 94
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET RGBOFFSET
1
GET RGBOFFSET
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
GET RGBOFFSET
Function RGB offset adjustment value inquiry
Format
GET□RGBOFFSET
?△RGBOFFSET
g:RGBOFFSET=<R adjustment value: Number>▽<G adjustment value: Number>▽<B
adjustment value: Number>
Response
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire about the current RGB offset adjustment values.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
The RGB offset can be set using the RGBOFFSET command.
)
(2)
Example > GET RGBOFFSET or ? RGBOFFSET
< g:RGBOFFSET=-10, 0, 19
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 95
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET ACADJUST
User Command Specifications
1
GET ACADJUST
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET ACADJUST
Function Advanced color adjustment inquiry
GET□ACADJUST
?△ACADJUST
Format
Response
g:ACADJUST=<Details of adjustment:ID>
Details of adjustment Meaning
NOCORRECT
MEM_L
MEM_M
MEM_H
6AX
No adjustment
Low memory color adjustment
Medium memory color adjustment
High memory color adjustment
6-axis adjustment
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the details of the current advanced color adjustment.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The advanced color adjustment can be set by the ACADJUST command.
Example > GET ACADJUST or ? ACADJUST
< g:ACADJUST=6AX
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
×
SX60
01.01**
×
X600
01.01**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
○
-
×
×
×
×
○
-
○
-
○
-
-
-
-
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX50
SX6
-
-
-
-
-
-
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 96
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET MEMCADJ
1
GET MEMCADJ
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
GET MEMCADJ
Function Memory color adjustment setting inquiry
Format
GET□MEMCADJ
?△MEMCADJ
g:MEMCADJ=<Details of adjustment:ID>
Response
Details of adjustment
OFF
MEM_L
Meaning
No adjustment
Low memory color adjustment
Medium memory color adjustment
High memory color adjustment
ID
MEM_M
MEM_H
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire about the current memory color adjustment setting.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
The memory color adjustment can be set using the MEMCADJ command.
)
(2)
>
<
Example
GET MEMCADJ or ? MEMCADJ
g:MEMCADJ=MEM_M
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 97
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET 6AXADJ
1
GET 6AXADJ
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
GET 6AXADJ
Function 6-axis adjustment ON/OFF inquiry
Format
GET□6AXADJ
?△6AXADJ
g:6AXADJ=<Setting:ID>
Setting Meaning
Response
ON
OFF
This sets the 6-axis adjustment to ON.
This sets the 6-axis adjustment to OFF.
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire whether the 6-axis adjustment is ON or OFF.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
ON or OFF for the 6-axis adjustment can be set using the 6AXADJ command.
)
(2)
>
<
Example
GET 6AXADJ or ? 6AXADJ
g:6AXADJ=ON
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 98
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command GET 6AXR-6AXY
1
GET 6AXR-6AXY
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET 6AXR-6AXY
Function 6-axis correction R to Y hue/color saturation setting inquiry
Format
R setting inquiry G setting inquiry B setting inquiry C setting inquiry M setting inquiry Y setting inquiry
GET□6AXR GET□6AXG GET□6AXB GET□6AXC GET□6AXM GET□6AXY
?△6AXR
?△6AXG
?△6AXB
?△6AXC
?△6AXM
?△6AXY
Response
g:6AXR(G,B,C,M,Y)=<Hue value: Number>▽<Color saturation: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current 6-axis correction R to Y hue and color saturation settings.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The 6-axis correction R to Y can be set by the 6AXR to Y command.
Example > GET 6AXR or ? 6AXR
< g:6AXR=12, -8
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 99
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET LAMP
User Command Specifications
1
GET LAMP
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET LAMP
Function Lamp output setting inquiry
GET□LAMP
?□LAMP
Format
Response
g:LAMP=<Setting:ID>
Setting Meaning
NORMAL Normal
SILENT Silent cooling
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current lamp output setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The lamp output can be set by the LAMP command.
Example > GET LAMP or ? LAMP
< g:LAMP=NORMAL
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 100
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET VKS/HKS
User Command Specifications
1
GET VKS/HKS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET VKS/HKS
Function Vertical/horizontal keystone setting inquiry
Format
Vertical keystone setting inquiry
GET□VKS
Horizontal keystone setting inquiry
GET□HKS
?△VKS
?△HKS
Response
g:VKS=<Vertical keystone setting: Number>
g:HKS=<Horizontal keystone setting: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description These inquire about the current vertical and horizontal keystone settings.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The vertical and horizontal keystone settings can be selected by the VKS and HKS commands,
respectively.
Example > GET VKS or ? VKS
< g:VKS=-23
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 101
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET AVOL
User Command Specifications
1
GET AVOL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET AVOL
Function Audio volume setting inquiry
GET□AVOL
?△AVOL
Format
Response
g:AVOL=<Volume setting: Number>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current audio volume setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The audio volume can be set by the AVOL command.
Example > GET AVOL or ? AVOL
< g:AVOL=18
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 102
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET MUTE
User Command Specifications
1
GET MUTE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET MUTE
Function Mute control setting inquiry
GET□MUTE
?△MUTE
Format
Response
g:MUTE=<Setting:ID>
Setting Meaning
ON
OFF
This turns off the audio/beep sound.
This returns the audio/beep sound to its original setting.
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current mute control setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 Mute control can be set by the MUTE command.
Example > GET MUTE or ? MUTE
< g:MUTE=ON
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 103
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET BVOL
User Command Specifications
1
GET BVOL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET BVOL
Function Beep sound value setting inquiry
GET□BVOL
?△BVOL
Format
Response
g:BVOL=<Setting ID>
Setting Meaning
0
1
BEEP sound mute
BEEP sound output
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current beep sound value set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The beep sound can be set using the BVOL command.
Example > GET BVOL or ? BVOL
< g:BVOL=ON
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 104
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command GET IMAGEFLIP
1
GET IMAGEFLIP
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET IMAGEFLIP
Function Flip display setting inquiry
GET□IMAGEFLIP
?△IMAGEFLIP
Format
Response
g:IMAGEFLIP=<Setting:ID>
Setting
Meaning
Remarks
Flip horizontally
NONE
CEILING
REAR
None
Ceiling
Rear
ID
Flip vertically
Flip horizontally and vertically
REAR_CEILING Rear ceiling
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current flip display setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The flip display can be set using the IMAGEFLIP command.
Example > GET IMAGEFLIP or ? IMAGEFLIP
< g:IMAGEFLIP=REAR_CEILING
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 105
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command GET PMM
1
GET PMM
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET PMM
Function Power management setting inquiry
GET□PMM
?△PMM
Format
Response
g:PMM=<Setting:ID>
Setting
Meaning
OFF
STANDBY
EXIT
Off
Standby mode
Exit mode
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current power management setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command)
-2 Power management can be set by the PMM command.
Example > GET PMM or ? PMM
< g:PMM=EXIT
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 106
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command GET PJON
1
GET PJON
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET PJON
Function Screen displayed at startup setting inquiry
GET□PJON
?△PJON
Format
Response
g:PJON=<Setting:ID>
Setting Meaning
CANON Canon logo
SKIP
No display
ID
LOGO User screen
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current setting for the screen to be displayed at startup.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The setting for the screen displayed at startup can be set by the PJON command.
Example > GET PJON or ? PJON
< g:PJON=SKIP
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 107
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET NOSIG
User Command Specifications
1
GET NOSIG
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET NOSIG
Function Screen displayed at startup with no signals setting inquiry
GET□NOSIG
?△NOSIG
Format
Response
g:NOSIG=<Setting:ID>
Setting Meaning
BLACK Black screen
BLUE Blue screen
LOGO User screen
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current setting for the screen to be displayed when there are no signals.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The display screen when there are no signals can be set by the NOSIG command.
Example > GET NOSIG or ? NOSIG
< g:NOSIG=LOGO
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 108
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET NOSHOW
User Command Specifications
1
GET NOSHOW
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET NOSHOW
Function Display screen when nothing is shown setting inquiry
GET□NOSHOW
?△NOSHOW
Format
Response
g:NOSHOW=<Setting:ID>
Setting Meaning
BLACK Black screen
BLUE Blue screen
LOGO User screen
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current setting for the screen to be displayed when nothing is shown.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The current display screen when nothing is shown can be set by the NOSHOW command.
Example > GET NOSHOW or ? NOSHOW
< g:NOSHOW=LOGO
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 109
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET LOGOPOS
User Command Specifications
1
GET LOGOPOS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET LOGOPOS
Function User image position inquiry
GET□LOGOPOS
?△LOGOPOS
Format
Response
g:LOGOPOS=<Setting:ID>
Setting
Meaning
UPPER_L
UPPER_R
CENTER
LOWER_L
LOWER_R
Upper left
Upper right
Center
Lower left
Lower right
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current user screen (logo) display position.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
An inquiry cannot be made if the user image has not been registered.
(The error "e:1002 NO_LOGO_CAPTURED" is returned.)
-2
-3 The user image position can be set by the LOGOPOS command.
Example > GET LOGOPOS or ? LOGOPOS
< g:LOGOPOS=LOWER_L
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 110
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command GET LANG
1
GET LANG
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET LANG
Function Language inquiry
GET□LANG
?△LANG
Format
Response
g:LANG=<Language:ID>
Errors supported by model
Language
Meaning
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
ENG
FRA
GER
ITA
English
French
German
Italian
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
SPA
POR
SWE
DUT
RUS
CHS
CHT
KOR
JPN
FIN
NOR
TUR
POL
HUN
CZE
DAN
Spanish
Portuguese
Swedish
Dutch
Russian
Chinese (simplified)
Chinese (traditional)
Korean
Japanese
Finnish
Norwegian
Turkish
Polish
ID
Hungarian
Czech
Danish
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current language selection.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The language can be set by the LANG command.
Example > GET LANG or ? LANG
< g:LANG=SWE
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 111
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command GET TERMINAL
1
GET TERMINAL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET TERMINAL
Function Terminal setting inquiry
GET□TERMINAL
?△TERMINAL
Format
Response
g:TERMINAL=<Setting:ID>
Setting Meaning
IN
OUT
This sets to input
This sets to output
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current terminal setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The terminal can be set by the TERMINAL command.
Example > GET TERMINAL or ? TERMINAL
< g:TERMINAL=OUT
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
×
SX60
01.01**
×
X600
01.01**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Parameter
Power
Input
Mode
OFF ON PM
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
IN
SX50
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
OUT
×
×
SX6
SX60
X600
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'TERMINAL_OUT' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 112
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET KEYLOCK
User Command Specifications
1
GET KEYLOCK
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET KEYLOCK
Function Key lock setting inquiry
GET□KEYLOCK
?△KEYLOCK
Format
Response
g:KEYLOCK=<Setting:ID>
Setting Meaning
OFF
MAIN
RC
No locking (OFF)
Main key lock
Remote control key lock
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current key lock setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 Key lock can be set by the KEYLOCK command.
Example > GET KEYLOCK or ? KEYLOCK
< g:KEYLOCK=OFF
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 113
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET RCCH
User Command Specifications
1
GET RCCH
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET RCCH
Function Remote control setting inquiry
GET□RCCH
?△RCCH
Format
Response
g:RCCH=<Setting:ID>
Setting Meaning
1
2
Remote control channel 1
Remote control channel 2
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current remote control setting.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 Remote control can be set by the RCCH command.
Example > GET RCCH or ? RCCH This inquires about the current remote control setting.
< g:RCCH=1
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 114
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET GUID
1
GET GUIDE
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
GET GUIDE
Function Guide setting inquiry
Format
GET□GUIDE
?△GUIDE
g:GUIDE=<Setting:ID>
Setting Meaning
Response
ON
OFF
Guide display ON
Guide display OFF
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire about the current guide setting.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
The guide can be set using the GUIDE command.
)
(2)
>
<
Example
GET GUIDE or ? GUIDE
g:GUIDE=OFF
An inquiry is made about the current guide setting.
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
ー
×
ー
○
ー
×
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
-
-
ー
○
ー
○
ー
×
○
○
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 115
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET DPON
1
GET DPON
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
GET DPON
Function Direct power-on setting inquiry
Format
GET□DPON
?△DPON
g:DPON=<Setting:ID>
Response
Setting Meaning
ON
OFF
This sets direct power-on to ON.
This sets direct power-on to OFF.
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire about the current direct power-on setting.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
Direct power-on can be set using the DPON command.
>
<
Example
GET DPON or ? DPON
g:DPON=OFF
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
Commands
supported 01.00**
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
ー
×
ー
○
ー
×
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
-
-
ー
○
ー
○
ー
×
○
○
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 116
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET LEDILLUMINATE
1
GET LEDILLUMINATE
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
GET LEDILLUMINATE
Function Emotional LED and signal sensing LED lighting setting inquiry
Format
GET□LEDILLUMINATE
?△LEDILLUMINATE
g:LEDILLUMINATE=<Setting:ID>
Response
Setting Meaning
ON
OFF
This sets the LED display to ON.
This sets the LED display to OFF.
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
This command is used to inquire about the current emotional LED and signal sensing LED lighting control
Description settings.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
LED lighting control can be set using the LEDILLUMINATE command.
)
(2)
>
<
Example
GET LEDILLUMINATE or ? LEDILLUMINATE
g:LEDILLUMINATE=OFF
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
ー
×
ー
○
ー
×
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
-
-
ー
○
ー
○
ー
×
○
○
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 117
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET NOSHOWSTATUS
1
GET NOSHOWSTATE
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
Function NoShow status inquiry
GET NOSHOWSTATE
Format
GET□NOSHOWSTATE
?△NOSHOWSTATE
g:NOSHOWSTATE=<Status:ID>
Status Meaning
Response
ON
OFF
Screen temporarily off
Screen not temporarily off
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire about the current NoShow status.
(1) This inquiry can be made at any time provided that the power-on status is established.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
No show status ON/OFF is controlled using the "RC NOSHOW" command in the local mode. (Toggling)
)
(2)
>
<
Example
GET NOSHOWSTATE or ? NOSHOWSTATE
g:NOSHOWSTATE=ON
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned as an error response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 118
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET FREEZE
1
GET FREEZE
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
GET FREEZE
Function Freeze status inquiry
Format
GET□FREEZE
?△FREEZE
g:FREEZE=<Status:ID>
Status Meaning
Response
ON
OFF
Image now frozen
Image now not frozen
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire about the current NoShow status.
(1) This inquiry can be made at any time provided that the power-on status is established.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
Freeze status ON/OFF is controlled using the "RC FREEZE" command in the local mode. (Toggling)
)
(2)
>
<
Example
GET FREEZE or ? FREEZE
g:FREEZE=ON
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned as an error response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 119
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET SIGNALSTATUS
User Command Specifications
1
GET SIGNALSTATUS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET SIGNALSTATUS
Function Signal status inquiry
GET□SIGNALSTATUS
?△SIGNALSTATUS
Format
Response
g:SIGNALSTATUS=<Signal status:ID>
Signal status
Meaning
NO_SIGNAL Signal not detected
DISPLAYING Image now displayed or display enable status
SETTING Signal detection and display preparation in progress
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current image signal input status.
-1
This inquiry can be made at any time provided that thepower-on status is established.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
For the "SX50," the remote mode must be established.
-2 This returns the signal status of the selected input. Use INPUT command for the input selection.
-3 Even if the status is "DISPLAYING" (image now shown), the image is not displayed during blanking.
Check the status using GET BLANK. To clear the blank status, use BLANK=OFF.
-4 Similarly, the image is not displayed during "no show".
Check the status using GET NOSHOWSTATUS.
To clear no show, execute RC NOSHOW.
Example > GET SIGNALSTATUS or ? SIGNALSTATUS
< g:SIGNALSTATUS=NO_SIGNAL
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 120
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET LAMPCOUNTER
User Command Specifications
1
GET LAMPCOUNTER
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET LAMPCOUNTER
Function Lamp ON time inquiry
GET□LAMPCOUNTER
?△LAMPCOUNTER
Format
Response
g:LAMPCOUNTER="<Lamp ON time: Character string>"
Meaning (ON time: H)
Lamp ON time
SX50
SX50
SX50
SX50
"[G_______]"
"[GG______]"
0 ~ 199
0 ~ 279
0 ~ 459
0 ~ 279
200
400
280
560
460
920
280
560
~
~
~
~
399
599
799
999
~
~
559
839
~
919
~
~
559
839
"[GGG_____]"
"[GGGG____]"
"[GGGGG___]"
"[GGGGGY__]"
"[GGGGGYY_]"
"[GGGGGYYR]"
~ 1379
~ 1839
~ 2299
~ 2399
~ 2499
Character
string
600
840
1380
1840
2300
2400
840
~ 1119
~ 1399
~ 1449
~ 1499
~ 1119
~ 1399
~ 1449
~ 1499
800
1120
1400
1450
1120
1400
1450
1000
1200
~ 1199
~ 1399
1400 ~
1500 ~
2500 ~
1500 ~
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current lamp ON time.
-1 This inquiry can be executed in any status provided that AC power is supplied to the projector.
For the "SX50," the projector must be in the remote mode and power-on status.
Example > GET LAMPCOUNTER or ? LAMPCOUNTER
< g:LAMPCOUNTER="[GG______]"
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 121
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET ERR
User Command Specifications
1
GET ERR
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET ERR
Function Error information inquiry
GET□ERR
?△ERR
Format
Response
g:ERR=<ErrorID:ID>
Errors supported by model
SX50 SX6 SX60 X600
Error ID
Meaning
No error
NO_ERROR
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
ABNORMAL_TEMPERATUR Temperature error
FAULTY_LAMP
Lamp error
FAULTY_LAMP_COVER
FAULTY_COOLING_FAN
Lamp cover error
Cooling fan error
ID
FAULTY_POWER_SUPPLY Power supply error
FAULTY_AK
AK error
FAULTY_ASC
ASC error
AF error
–
FAULTY_AF
–
FAULTY_POWER_ZOOM
FAULTY_POWER_FOCUS
Zoom error
Focus error
–
–
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the current error information.
-1 This inquiry can be executed in any status provided that AC power is supplied to the projector.
For the "SX50," the remote mode must be established.
-2
Information when the warning LED of the projector is flashing can be obtained.
"NO_ERROR" is returned when the warning LED is not lighted.
Example > GET ERR or ? ERR
< g:ERR=FAULTY_LAMP
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 122
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET PRODCODE
User Command Specifications
1
GET PRODCODE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET PRODCODE
Function Product information inquiry
GET□PRODCODE
?△PRODCODE
Format
Response
g:PRODCODE="<Product name: Character string>"
Product name
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
Character
string
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the product name of the projector.
-1 This inquiry can be executed in any status provided that AC power is supplied to the projector.
For the "SX50," the projector must be in the remote mode and power-on status.
Example > GET PRODCODE or ? PRODCODE
< g:PRODCODE="SX50"
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 123
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command GET ROMVER
1
GET ROMVER
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET ROMVER
Function ROM version inquiry
GET□ROMVER
?△ROMVER
Format
Response
g:ROMVER="<ROM VERSION:Character string>"
<ROM VERSION> := 99.9999
Character
string
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the product name of the projector.
-1 This inquiry can be executed in any status provided that AC power is supplied to the projector.
For the "SX50," the projector must be in the remote mode and power-on status.
Example > GET ROMVER or ? ROMVER
< g:ROMVER="01.0306"
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 124
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command GET COMVER
User Command Specifications
1
GET COMVER
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
GET COMVER
Function User command version inquiry
GET□COMVER
?△COMVER
Format
Response
g:COMVER="<User command version:Character string>"
<User command version> := 99.9999
Character
string
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the user command version of the projector.
-1 This inquiry can be executed in any status provided that AC power is supplied to the projector.
For the "SX50," the remote mode must be established.
-2
The user command version consists of a 2-digit number followed by a 4-digit number. Question
marks may appear in place of the numerals if the firmware has not been upgraded correctly.
(Example "??:????")
Example > GET COMVER or ? COMVER
< g:COMVER="01.0000"
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 125
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command RANGE
2
RANGE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE
Function Setting range request
RANGE□ <Parameter>
Format
Parameter
Parameter
POWER
BLANK
AUTOSETEXE
INPUT
Meaning
Power supply state
Blank setting
Auto setup
Input state
DOTS
TRACK
HPOS
VPOS
HPIX
Total number of dot
Tracking
Horizontal position
Vertical position
Horizontal resolution
Vertical resolution
Input
signal
settings
VPIX
SEL
Input signal
ASPECT
IMAGE
BRI
Screem size
Image settings
Brightness setting value
Contrast setting value
Sharpness setting value
Gamma correction
CONT
SHARP
GAMMA
DGAMMA
PROG
Dynamic gamma
Progressive
WB
WBRGB
SAT
Screen color correction
Screen color correction value (RGB)
Color saturation setting value
Hue setting value
HUE
RGBGAIN
RGBOFFSET
ACADJUST
MEMCADJ
6AXADJ
6AXR
RGB gain adjustment
RGB offset adjustment
Advanced color correction method
Memory color correction
6-axis adjustment ON/OFF
R setting value
ID
6AXG
6AXB
6AXC
6AXM
G setting value
6-axis
B setting value
color
C setting value
adjust
M setting value
Y setting value
6AXY
VKS
HKS
AVOL
Vertical keystone distortion values
Horizontal keystone distortion values
Volume adjustment
MUTE
Mute state
BVOL
IMAGEFLIP
PMM
Beep sound setting status
Flip display status
Power management
PJON
Display screen at startup setting
NOSIG
NOSHOW
LOGOPOS
LANG
Display screen when there are no signals setting
Display screen when nothing shown
User image position
Language
LAMP
Lamp output
TERMINAL
KEYLOCK
RCCH
Terminal setting
Key lock
Remote control Ch
GUIDE
DPON
Guide display setting
Direct power-on setting
LED display setting
Zoom step control
Zoom continuous control
Focus step control
LEDILLUMINATE
ZSTEPDRV
ZCONTDRV
FSTEPDRV
FCONTDRV
Focus continuous control
PAGE 126
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9. Details of command RANGE
Response Responses are made in the formats below for each parameter.
<Parameter name>=<Type>, <Setting range>
Type
Meaning
I
ID
N
Number
The definition of <Setting range> varies depending on the type.
1. When the type is I (ID)
<Setting range>: = <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, <Setting option 3>,
<Setting option 4>, …, <Setting option N>
2. When the type is N (Number)
<Setting range>: = <Setting option 1 minimum value>, <Setting option 1 maximum
value>, <Setting option 2 minimum value>, <Setting option 2 maximum value>, …,
<Setting option N minimum value>, <Setting option N maximum value>
Description This retrieves the setting range of each parameter.
-1
-2
The setting ranges of the setting or control command parameters may differ depending on the
projector status (input, display mode, etc.).
To ensure reliability, request the setting ranges before sending the setting or control
commands.
(Once the setting ranges have been obtained, the setting or control commands can be
For further details, refer to the descriptions of the commands.
-3
PAGE 127
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE POWER
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE POWER
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE POWER
Function Power control setting option request
RANGE□POWER
Format
Response
r:POWER=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, ..., <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the power control setting options.
-1 This inquiry can be executed in any status provided that AC power is supplied to the projector.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With the SX50, the inquiry can be made in the remote mode only.
-2 The power can be controlled by the POWER command.
Example > RANGE POWER
< r:POWER=I, ON, OFF
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' is returned as an error response.
PAGE 128
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE BLANK
1
RANGE BLANK
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE BLANK
Function BLANK setting option request
Format
RANGE□BLANK
Response
r:BLANK=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
Description This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable BLANK to be set.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
The BLANK can be controlled using the BLANK command.
)
(2)
Example > RANGE BLANK
< r:BLANK=I, ON, OFF
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
-
-
○
-
○
-
×
○
○
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 129
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE AUTOSETEXE
1
RANGE AUTOSETEXE
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE AUTOSETEXE
Function Auto setup setting option request
Format
RANGE□AUTOSETEXE
Response
r:AUTOSETEXE=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
Description This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable auto setup to be set.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
Auto setup can be controlled using the AUTOSETEXE command.
)
(2)
Example > RANGE AUTOSETEXE
< r:AUTOSETEXE=I, FOCUS, VKS, SCRN, INPUT
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
-
-
○
-
○
-
×
○
○
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 130
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE INPUT
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE INPUT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE INPUT
Function Input selection setting option request
RANGE□INPUT
Format
Response
r:INPUT=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable input selection to be set.
This inquiry can be made in the power-on status.
-1
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With the SX50, the inquiry can be made in the remote mode only.
-2 The input selection can be controlled by the INPUT command.
Example > RANGE INPUT
< r:INPUT=I, D-RGB, A-RGB1, A-RGB2, COMP, VIDEO, S-VIDEO
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
-
○
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 131
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE DOTS
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE DOTS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE DOTS
Function Total dot number setting range inquiry
RANGE□DOTS
Format
Response
r:DOTS=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the range within which the total number of dots can be set.
-1 This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2 The total number of dots can be set by the DOTS command.
Example
> RANGE DOTS
< r:DOTS=N, 0, 4096
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 132
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE TRACK
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE TRACK
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE TRACK
Function Tracking adjustment range request
RANGE□TRACK
Format
Response
r:TRACK=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the values to which the tracking can be adjusted.
-1 This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2 The tracking adjustment can be set by the TRACK command.
Example > RANGE TRACK
< r:TRACK=N, 0, 31
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 133
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE HPOS/VPOS
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE HPOS/VPOS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE HPOS/VPOS
Function Horizontal/vertical position adjustment range request
Format
Horizontal position adjustment range inquiry Vertical position adjustment range inquiry
RANGE□HPOS RANGE□VPOS
Response
r:HPOS=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
r:VPOS=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description These inquire about the ranges within which the horizontal and vertical positions can be adjusted.
-1 This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
-2
The horizontal and vertical position adjustments can be set using the HPOS and VPOS
commands, respectively.
Example > RANGE VPOS
< r:VPOS=N, 0, 820
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 134
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE HPIX/VPIX
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE HPIX/VPIX
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE HPIX/VPIX
Function Horizontal/vertical resolution setting range request
Format
Horizontal resolution setting range inquirVertical resolution setting range inquiry
RANGE□HPIX RANGE□VPIX
Response
r:HPIX=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
r:VPIX=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description These inquire about the ranges within which the horizontal and vertical resolutions can be set.
-1
-2
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
The horizontal and vertical resolutions can be set using the HPIX and VPIX commands,
respectively.
Example > RANGE VPIX
< r:VPIX=N, 0, 1000
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 135
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE SEL
1
RANGE SEL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE SEL
Function Input signal setting option request
RANGE□SEL
Format
Response
r:SEL=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the input signals to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
The input signals can be selected by the SEL command.
-2
Example > RANGE SEL
< r:SEL=I, AUTO
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 136
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE ASPECT
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE ASPECT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE ASPECT
Function Screen setting option request
RANGE□ASPECT
Format
Response
r:ASPECT=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the screen to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
The screen settings can be selected by the ASPECT command.
-2
Example > RANGE ASPECT
< r:ASPECT=I, AUTO, NORMAL, WIDE
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 137
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE IMAGE
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE IMAGE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE IMAGE
Function Image mode setting option request
RANGE□IMAGE
Format
Response
r:IMAGE=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the image mode to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The image mode settings can be selected by the IMAGE command.
-2
Example > RANGE IMAGE
< r:IMAGE=I, STANDARD, PRESENTATION, CINEMA, SRGB
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 138
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE BRI
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE BRI
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE BRI
Function Brightness setting range request
RANGE□BRI
Format
Response
r:BRI=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Number
Description This inquires about the range of values at which the brightness can be set.
-1
-2
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The brightness can be set by the BRI command.
Example > RANGE BRI
< r:BRI=N, -20, 20
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 139
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE CONT
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE CONT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE CONT
Function Contrast setting range request
RANGE□CONT
Format
Response
r:CONT=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the range within which the contrast can be set.
-1
-2
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The contrast can be set by the CONT command.
Example > RANGE CONT
< r:CONT=N, -20, 20
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 140
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE SHARP
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE SHARP
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE SHARP
Function Sharpness setting range request
RANGE□SHARP
Format
Response
r:SHARP=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the range within which the sharpness can be set.
-1
-2
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The sharpness can be set by the SHARP command.
Example > RANGE SHARP
< r:SHARP=N, -4, 4
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 141
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE GAMMA
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE GAMMA
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE GAMMA
Function Gamma adjustment range request
RANGE□GAMMA
Format
Response
r:GAMMA=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the range within which the gamma can be adjusted.
-1
-2
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The gamma adjustment value can be set by the GAMMA command.
Example > RANGE GAMMA
< r:GAMMA=N, -4, 4
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 142
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE DGAMMA
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE DGAMMA
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE DGAMMA
Function Dynamic gamma setting option request
RANGE□DGAMMA
Format
Response
r:DGAMMA=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the dynamic gamma to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The dynamic gamma setting value can be selected by the DGAMMA command.
Example > RANGE DGAMMA
< r:DGAMMA=I, 0, 1
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 143
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE PROG
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE PROG
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE PROG
Function Progressive setting option request
RANGE□PROG
Format
Response
r:PROG=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the progressive setting to be selected.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
The progressive setting can be selected by the PROG command.
-2
Example > RANGE PROG
< r:PROG=I, 0, 1, 2
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
×
–
×
×
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 144
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE WB
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE WB
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE WB
Function Screen color correction option request
RANGE□WB
Format
Response
r:WB=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the screen color to be corrected.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The screen color correction can be set by the WB command.
-2
Example > RANGE WB
< r:WB=I, NORMAL, GREENBOARD, ADJUST
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 145
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE WBRGB
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE WBRGB
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE WBRGB
Function Screen color correction (adjustment) range request
RANGE□WBRGB
Format
r:WBRGB=N, <R minimum value>, <R maximum value>, <G minimum value>,
<G maximum value>, <B minimum value>, <B maximum value>
Response
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the range within which the screen color correction (adjustment) can be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The screen color correction (adjustment) can be set by the WBRGB command.
-2
Example > RANGE WBRGB
< r:WBRGB=N, -20, 20, -20, 20, -20, 20
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 146
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE SAT
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE SAT
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE SAT
Function Color saturation setting range request
RANGE□SAT
Format
Response
r:SAT=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Number
Description This inquires about the range within which the color saturation can be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
The color saturation can be set by the SAT command.
-2
Example > RANGE SAT
< r:SAT=N, -20, 20
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
×
–
×
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
SX60
X600
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 147
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE HUE
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE HUE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE HUE
Function Hue setting range request
RANGE□HUE
Format
Response
r:HUE=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the range within which the hue can be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
With some input signals, it may not be possible to make this inquiry.
The hue can be set by the HUE command.
-2
Example > RANGE HUE
< r:HUE=N, -20, 20
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
○
–
–
○
–
–
○
–
○
×
SX50
×
×
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
–
–
○
×
SX6
SX60
X600
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
○
×
–
○
○
×
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'INVALID_SOURCE' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'INVALID_SIGNAL (*****)' or 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 148
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE RGBGAIN
1
RANGE RGBGAIN
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE RGBGAIN
Function RGB gain adjustment range request
Format
RANGE□RGBGAIN
Response
r:RGBGAIN=N, <R minimum value>, <R maximum value>, <G minimum value>, <G
maximum value>, <B minimum value>, <B maximum value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire about the range in which the RGB gain adjustment can be set.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
The RGB gain can be set using the RGBGAIN command.
)
(2)
Example > RANGE RGBGAIN
< r:RGBGAIN=N, -20, 20, -20, 20, -20, 20
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 149
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE RGBOFFSET
1
RANGE RGBOFFSET
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE RGBOFFSET
Function RGB offset adjustment range inquiry
Format
RANGE□RGBOFFSET
Response
r:RGBOFFSET=N, <R minimum value>, <R maximum value>, <G minimum value>, <G
maximum value>, <B minimum value>, <B maximum value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This command is used to inquire about the current RGB offset adjustment values.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
The RGB offset can be set using the RGBOFFSET command.
)
(2)
Example > RANGE RGBOFFSET
< r:RGBOFFSET=N, -20, 20, -20, 20, -20, 20
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 150
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE ACADJUST
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE ACADJUST
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE ACADJUST
Function Advanced color adjustment option request
RANGE□ACADJUST
Format
Response
r:ACADJUST=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the advanced color adjustment to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The advanced color adjustment can be set by the ACADJUST command.
-2
Example > RANGE ACADJUST
< r:ACADJUST=I, NOCORRECT, MEM_L, MEM_M, MEM_H, 6AX
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
×
SX60
01.01**
×
X600
01.01**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
–
○
×
–
×
–
×
–
×
–
○
○
○
–
–
–
–
○
○
×
–
SX50
SX6
–
–
–
–
–
–
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 151
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE MEMCADJ
1
RANGE MEMCADJ
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE MEMCADJ
Function Memory color adjustment setting option request
Format
RANGE□MEMCADJ
Response
r:MEMCADJ=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
Description
This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable the memory color adjustment
to be set.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
The memory color adjustment can be set using the MEMCADJ command.
)
(2)
Example > RANGE MEMCADJ
< r:MEMCADJ=I, OFF, MEM_L, MEM_M, MEM_H
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 152
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE 6AXADJ
1
RANGE 6AXADJ
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE 6AXADJ
Function 6-axis adjustment option inquiry
Format
RANGE□6AXADJ
Response
r:6AXADJ=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
Description This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable the 6-axis adjustment to be set.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
ON or OFF for the 6-axis adjustment can be set using the 6AXADJ command.
Example > RANGE 6AXADJ
< r:6AXADJ=I, ON, OFF
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 153
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE 6AXR-6AXY
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE 6AXR-6AXY
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE 6AXR-6AXY
Function 6-axis correction R to Y hue/color saturation setting range request
Format
R range inquiry G range inquiry B range inquiry C range inquiry M range inquiry Y range inquiry
RANGE□6AXR RANGE□6AXG RANGE□6AXB RANGE□6AXC RANGE□6AXM RANGE□6AXY
Response
r:6AXR(G,B,C,M,Y)=N, <Minimum hue value>, <Maximum hue value>,
<Minimum color saturation value>, <Maximum color saturation value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description
This inquires about the range within which the 6-axis correction R to Y hue and color saturation can be
set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The 6-axis correction R to Y can be set by the 6AXR to Y command.
Example > RANGE 6AXC
< r:6AXC=N, -20, 20, -20, 20
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 154
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE LAMP
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE LAMP
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE LAMP
Function Lamp output setting option request
RANGE□LAMP
Format
Response
r:LAMP=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the lamp output to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The lamp output can be set by the LAMP command.
-2
Example > RANGE LAMP
< r:LAMP=I, NORMAL, SILENT
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 155
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE VKS/HKS
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE VKS/HKS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE VKS/HKS
Function Vertical/horizontal keystone setting range request
Format
Vertical keystone setting range inquiry Horizontal keystone setting range inquiry
RANGE□VKS RANGE□HKS
Response
r:VKS=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
r:HKS=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description These inquire about the ranges within which the vertical and horizontal keystone can be set.
-1
-2
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The vertical and horizontal keystone settings can be selected by the VKS and HKS commands,
respectively.
Example > RANGE HKS
< r:HKS=N, -30, 30
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
×
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* If the necessary signals are not input, 'NO_SIGNAL' is returned.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 156
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE AVOL
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE AVOL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE AVOL
Function Audio volume setting range request
RANGE□AVOL
Format
Response
r:AVOL=N, <Minimum setting value>, <Maximum setting value>
Number
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the range within which the audio volume can be set.
-1
-2
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The audio volume can be set by the AVOL command.
Example > RANGE AVOL
< r:AVOL=N, 0, 20
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 157
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE MUTE
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE MUTE
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE MUTE
Function Mute control setting option request
RANGE□MUTE
Format
Response
r:MUTE=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable mute control to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 Mute control can be set by the MUTE command.
Example > RANGE MUTE
< r:MUTE=I, ON, OFF
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 158
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE BVOL
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE BVOL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE BVOL
Function Beep sound setting option request
RANGE□BVOL
Format
Response
r:BVOL=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the beep sound to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The beep sound can be set using the BVOL command.
Example > RANGE BVOL
< r:BVOL=I, 0, 1
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 159
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9 .Details of command RANGE IMAGEFLIP
1
RANGE IMAGEFLIP
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE IMAGEFLIP
Function Flip display setting option request
RANGE□IMAGEFLIP
Format
Response
r:IMAGEFLIP=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the flip display to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The flip display can be set using the IMAGEFLIP command.
-2
Example > RANGE IMAGEFLIP
< r:IMAGEFLIP=I, NONE, CEILING, REAR, REAR_SEILING
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 160
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9 .Details of command RANGE PMM
1
RANGE PMM
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE PMM
Function Power management setting option request
RANGE□PMM
Format
Response
r:PMM=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, ..., <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable power management to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 Power management can be set by the PMM command.
Example > RANGE PMM
< r:PMM=I, OFF, STANDBY, EXIT
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 161
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE PJON
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE PJON
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE PJON
Function Display screen at startup setting option request
RANGE□PJON
Format
Response
r:PJON=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the display screen setting at startup to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The setting for the screen displayed at startup can be set by the PJON command.
-2
Example > RANGE PJON
< r:PJON=I, CANON, SKIP, LOGO
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 162
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE NOSIG
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE NOSIG
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE NOSIG
Function Display screen when there are no signals setting option request
RANGE□PJON
Format
Response
r:NOSIG=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description
This inquires about the parameter options which enable the display screen when there are no signals to
be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The display screen when there are no signals can be set by the NOSIG command.
-2
Example > RANGE NOSIG
< r:NOSIG=I, BLACK, BLUE, LOGO
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 163
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE NOSHOW
1
RANGE NOSHOW
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE NOSHOW
Function Display screen when nothing is shown setting option request
RANGE□NOSHOW
Format
Response
r:NOSHOW=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description
This inquires about the parameter options which enable the display screen when nothing is shown to be
set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The current display screen when nothing is shown can be set by the NOSHOW command.
-2
Example > RANGE NOSHOW
< r:NOSHOW=I, BLACK, BLUE, LOGO
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 164
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE LOGOPOS
1
RANGE LOGOPOS
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE LOGOPOS
Function User image position setting option inquiry
RANGE□LOGOPOS
Format
Response
r:LOGOPOS=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description
This inquires about the parameter options which enable the user screen (logo) display position to be
set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
An inquiry cannot be made if the user image has not been registered.
(The "e:1002 NO_LOGO_CAPTURED" error is returned.)
The user image position can be set by the LOGOPOS command.
-2
-3
Example > RANGE LOGOPOS
< r:LOGOPOS=I, UPPER_L, UPPER_R, CENTER, LOWER_L, LOWER_R
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 165
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE LANG
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE LANG
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE LANG
Function Language setting option request
RANGE□LANG
Format
Response
r:LANG=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the language to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 The language can be set by the LANG command.
Example > RANGE LANG
<
r:LANG=I,ENG,FRA,GER,ITA,SPA,POR,SWE,DUT,RUS,CHS,CHT,KOR,JPN,FIN,NOR,TUR,
POL,HUN,CZE,DAN
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 166
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE TERMINAL
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE TERMINAL
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE TERMINAL
Function Terminal setting option request
RANGE□TERMINAL
Format
Response
r:TERMINAL=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable the terminal to be set.
-1
-2
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
The terminal can be set by the TERMINAL command.
Example > RANGE TERMINAL
< r:TERMINAL=I, IN, OUT
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
×
SX60
01.01**
×
X600
01.01**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Parameter
Power
Input
Mode
OFF ON PM
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
IN
SX50
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
OUT
×
×
SX6
SX60
X600
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
* If the command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE,' 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' or 'TERMINAL_OUT' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 167
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE KEYLOCK
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE KEYLOCK
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE KEYLOCK
Function Key lock setting option request
RANGE□KEYLOCK
Format
Response
r:KEYLOCK=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable key lock to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 Key lock can be set by the KEYLOCK command.
Example > RANGE KEYLOCK
< r:KEYLOCK=I, MAIN, RC
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 168
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9.Details of command RANGE RCCH
User Command Specifications
1
RANGE RCCH
Commands
Mode Control Setting Reference
RANGE RCCH
Function Remote control setting option request
RANGE□RCCH
Format
Response
r:RCCH=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
ID
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
Description This inquires about the parameter options which enable remote control to be set.
-1
This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both theremote mode and power-on status
at the same time.
A "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.)
-2 Remote control can be set by the RCCH command.
Example > RANGE RCCH
< r:RCCH=I, 1, 2
* Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
Commands
supported
SX50
01.00**
○
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Supported Command States
Model
Power
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
×
×
○
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
○
○
○
○
×
×
SX50
SX6
○
○
SX60
X600
* If a command cannot be supported, 'INVALID_MODE' or 'NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED' is returned as an error response.
* "i:BUSY" may be returned if the power status is being switched.
PAGE 169
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE GUID
1
RANGE GUIDE
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE GUIDE
Function Guide setting enable option request
Format
RANGE□GUIDE
Response
r:GUIDE=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
Description This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable the guide to be set.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
The guide can be set using the GUIDE command.
)
(2)
Example > RANGE GUIDE
< r:GUIDE=I, ON, OFF
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
ー
×
ー
○
ー
×
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
-
-
ー
○
ー
○
ー
×
○
○
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 170
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE DPON
1
RANGE DPON
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE DPON
Function Direct power-on setting inquiry
Format
RANGE□DPON
Response
r:DPON=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
Description This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable direct power-on to be set.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
Direct power-on can be set using the DPON command.
)
(2)
Example > RANGE DPON
< r:DPON=I, ON, OFF
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
ー
×
ー
○
ー
×
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
-
-
ー
○
ー
○
ー
×
○
○
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 171
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE LEDILLUMINATE
1
RANGE LEDILLUMINATE
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE LEDILLUMINATE
Function Emotional LED and signal sensing LED lighting setting option request
Format
RANGE□LEDILLUMINATE
Response
r:LEDILLUMINATE=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
Description
This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable emotional LED and signal
sensing LED lighting control to be set.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given while the zoom or focus lens is being driven.
(
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
LED lighting control can be set using the LEDILLUMINATE command.
)
(2)
Example > RANGE LEDILLUMINATE
< r:LEDILLUMINATE=I, ON, OFF
*Commands are indicated by ">", and responses are indicated by "<".
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
ー
×
ー
○
ー
×
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
ー
○
-
-
ー
○
ー
○
ー
×
○
○
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 172
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE ZSTEPDRV
1
RANGE ZSTEPDRV
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE ZSTEPDRV
Function Zoom lens step drive control option request
Format
RANGE□ZSTEPDRV
Response
r:ZSTEPDRV=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
Description This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable the step drive of the zoom lens.
(1) This inquiry can be mades when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given if the zoom or focus lens is being driven
(
.
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
Step control for the zoom lens can be exercised using the ZSTEPDRV command.
Example > RANGE ZSTEPDRV
< r:ZSTEPDRV=I, WIDE, TELE
SX50
Commands
supported 01.00**
SX6
SX60
X600
01.01**
○
01.01**
○
01.01**
○
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 173
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE ZCONTDRV
1
RANGE ZCONTDRV
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE ZCONTDRV
Function Zoom lens continuous drive control option request
Format
RANGE□CONTZDRV
Response
r:ZCONTDRV=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
Description
This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable the zoom lens to be driven
continuously.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given if the zoom or focus lens is being driven
(
.
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
Continuous control of the zoom lens can be exercised using the ZCONTDRV command.
Example > RANGE ZCONTDRV
r:ZCONTDRV=I, STOP, WIDE, TELE
<
SX50
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
Commands
supported 01.00**
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 174
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE FSTEPDRV
1
RANGE FSTEPDRV
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE FSTEPDRV
Function Focus lens step drive control option request
Format
RANGE□FSTEPDRV
Response
r:FSTEPDRV=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
Description This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable the step drive of the focus lens.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given if the zoom or focus lens is being driven
(
.
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
Step control for the focus lens can be exercised using the FSTEPDRV command.
Example > RANGE FSTEPDRV
< r:FSTEPDRV=I, FAR, NEAR
SX50
Commands
supported 01.00**
SX6
SX60
X600
01.01**
○
01.01**
○
01.01**
○
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 175
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
9.Details of command RANGE FCONTDRV
1
RANGE FCONTDRV
Reference
Mode Control Setting
Commands
RANGE FCONTDRV
Function Focus lens continuous drive control option request
Format
RANGE□FCONTDRV
Response
r:FCONTDRV=I, <Setting option 1>, <Setting option 2>, …, <Setting option n>
For all other responses, refer to "Error List."
ID
This command is used to inquire about the parameter options which enable the focus lens to be driven
Description continuously.
(1) This inquiry can be made when the projector is in both the remote mode and power-on status at
the same time.
However, a "busy" response is given if the zoom or focus lens is being driven
(
.
Refer to the ZCONTDRV command and FCONTDRV command.
)
(2)
Continuous control of the focus lens can be exercised using the FCONTDRV command.
Example > RANGE FCONTDRV
< r:FCONTDRV=I, STOP, FAR, NEAR
SX50
Commands
supported 01.00**
SX6
01.01**
○
SX60
01.01**
○
X600
01.01**
○
×
When a command is not supported, "e:000A INVALID_PARAMETER" is returned.
Supported Command States
Model Power supply
OFF ON PM
Input
Mode
Remarks
D-RGB A-RGB1 A-RGB2 Comp
Video S-Video D-Video SCART None Remote Local
SX50
SX6
-
×
-
○
-
×
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
×
SX60
X600
*If a state is not supported, "INVALID_MODE" or "NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED" is returned with the Err response.
*When the power supply state is in the process of switching, an "i:BUSY" reply may be sent.
PAGE 176
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
10. Error List
1 10. Error List
10. Error List
Errors
supported by
model
Code
Error character strings
Error
Remedy
(1)(2)(3)(4)
Wait until the response is received to send
the command.
Send the correct command.
Switch the mode using the REMOTE or
LOCAL command.
Send in the correct command format.
Use the POWER ON command to turn on
the power.
Wait until the power supply state changes
to “ON”, “OFF”, or “PMM”.
1 0001
2 0002
3 0003
4 0004
5 0005
e
e
e
e
e
BAD_SEQUENCE
Communication sequence error
○ ○ ○ ○
INVALID_COMMAND
INVALID_MODE
○ ○ ○ ○ Command is invalid (undefined).
The designated command cannot be
executed in this mode.
○ ○ ○ ○ The command format is incorrect.
○ ○ ○ ○
INVALID_FORMAT
NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED
Power is not being supplied.
○ ○ ○ ○
○ ○ ○ ○
Mode switching or processing inside the
projector is underway.
6
–
i
BUSY
The parameter (type) is invalid
7 000A
e
INVALID_PARAMETER
Use the correct parameter(s).
○ ○ ○ ○ (undefined).This includes the case when
the number of parameters is incorrect.
000B
–
JOB_TIMEOUT
SX50 internal processing has timed out.
Resend the command.
Use GET COMVER to obtain the latest
user command version.
8
9
e
○ ○ ○ ○
USER_COMMAND_VERSION_IS_UPDATED
w
The user command version is being updated.
The focus lens is now being driven.
The zoom lens is now being driven.
○ ○ ○ ○
○ ○ ○
BUSY (FOCUS)
BUSY (ZOOM)
Wait until the focus lens drive stops.
i
i
10
11
–
Wait until the zoom lens drive stops.
Resend the command.
○ ○ ○
F001
F002
F004
F005
e
e
e
e
SYSTEM (UNKNOWN)
SYSTEM (FOCUS)
SYSTEM (AUTO_KEYSTONE)
SYSTEM (SCREEN_COLOR)
○ ○ ○ ○ An internal error occurred.
○ ○ ○ An error occurred in AUTOSETEXE=FOCUS.
○ ○ ○ An error occurred in AUTOSETEXE=VKS.
○ ○ ○ An error occurred in AUTOSETEXE=SCRN.
Eliminate the cause of the error, and
resend the command.
A communication protocol violation
occurred in the projector.
12 E0XX
e
COMMUNICATION_ERROR
Resend the command.
○ ○ ○ ○
This cannot be executed with the current
input source.
The current input source is indicated in
parentheses.
There is no signal input.
This cannot be executed with the current
input signal.
The current input signal is indicated in
parentheses.
13 200X
2010
e
e
e
INVALID_SOURCE (****)
NO_SIGNAL
Change the input source.
Input the signal.
○ ○ ○ ○
○ ○ ○ ○
○ ○ ○ ○
14
201X
INVALID_SIGNAL (****)
Change the input signal.
i
i
i
i
BUSY (NOW_SETTING)
BUSY
(POWER_MANAGEMENT_READY)
BUSY (INTERNAL_PROCESS)
○ ○ ○ ○ Signal setting (detection) is in progress.
Preparing to switch to power management
standby.
Wait until the processing is completed.
○ ○ ○ ○
○ ○ ○ ○ Heavy processing is in progress.
15
16
–
BUSY (FOCUS)
BUSY (ZOOM)
The focus lens is now being driven.
The zoom lens is now being driven.
Wait until the focus lens drive stops.
Wait until the zoom lens drive stops.
○ ○ ○
○ ○ ○
i
0801
0802
Use the RANGE command to obtain the
parameter range, and then use a
parameter within the range.
Numerical parameters are invalid or
outside the range.
INVALID_VALUE
TERMINAL_OUT
e
○ ○ ○ ○
○
Use the TERMINAL command to set the
terminal to input, and then select the input
again.
The input cannot be selected since the
terminal is set to output.
1001
e
Processing cannot be executed since the
user image is not registered.
IP conversion cannot be performed.
DPON cannot be set to ON when PMM is
OFF.
PMM cannot be set to OFF when DPON is
ON.
AUTOSETEXE=FOCUS or SCRN cannot After setting BLANK to ON, resend the
1002
1003
e
e
e
NO_LOGO_CAPTURED
IP_NOT_AVAILABLE
Register the user image.
○ ○ ○ ○
○ ○ ○ ○
○ ○ ○
Change to the correct input signal.
Set DPON to ON when PMM is not OFF.
17 1004
1005
POWER_MANEGEMENT_OFF
e
e
e
i
DIRECT_POWER_ON
NOW_BLANK
Set DPON to OFF.
○ ○ ○
○ ○ ○
1006
be executed since BLANK is ON.
command.
Change to the correct resolution of the
input signal.
203X
INVALID_RESOLUTION (***)
INPUT_NOT_FOUND
The input signal resolution is not correct.
○ ○ ○ ○
○ ○ ○
The input was not switched since no input signal There is no action to be taken since the
was found with AUTOSETEXE=INPUT.
–
18
status has been notified.
※ The error code is expressed as a four-digit hexadecimal character string. ‘X’ is a number from ‘0’ to ‘9’ or letter from ‘A’ to ‘F’.
※ Errors with the newer item numbers have higher priority. (When there is more than one error, the highest level error is returned. However, error priority
is the same within the same item number.)
※ Given below is the correspondence between the numbers (1) to (4) in the "Errors supported by model" column and the models concerned.
(1) SX50
(2) SX6
(3) SX60
(4) X600
PAGE 177
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
11. Other
1 11. Other
11. Other
Use the remote control emulation function (RC command) in Local mode for the following functions.
Function
No display
RC command parameter
NOSHOW
Freeze screen
Digital zoom
FREEZE
DZOOM_P, DZOOM_M
Presentation timer
Spotlight function
P_TIMER
SPOT
PAGE 178
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
Appendix 1 Reset Items
1 Appendix 1 Reset Items
Appendix 1 Reset Items
What is initialized by the "RESET" command is set forth in the table below.
ALL SYSTEM IMAGE
Item
Setting
Reference command
INPUT
●
●
Input source switching
Toggle button recording
A-RGB2
C1:DRGB C2:ARGB2 ------------
V :VIDEO
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
ARGB manual for input signal setting
Input signal select
Input signal select (PC)
Screen settings
Menu display position
Logo included/not included
User image position
Screen in no show status
No signal screen
AUTO
not selected
FULL
CENTER
not included
CENTER
BLACK
BLUE
SEL
------------
ASPECT
------------
------------
LOGOPOS
NOSHOW
NOSIG
PJON
IMAGEFLIP
IMAGE
Startup screen
Flip display
Image mode
CANON
NONE
STANDARD
What is initialized in the image modes
STANDARD PRESEN
CINEMA
SRGB
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
Brightness
Contrast
Sharpness
Gamma
Dynamic gamma
Screen color correction
〃adjustment values (R,G,B)
Advanced color adjustment
6-axis adjustment (SAT,HUE)
Lamp mode
0
0
0
0
BRI
CONT
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SHARP
GAMMA
DGAMMA
WB
WBRGB
ACADJUST
6AXR~Y
LAMP
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
NORMAL
0, 0, 0
NORMAL
0, 0, 0
NORMAL
0, 0, 0
NORMAL
0, 0, 0
NOCORRECT NOCORRECT NOCORRECT NOCORRECT
0, 0
0, 0
0, 0
0, 0
NORMAL
NORMAL
SILENT
NORMAL
Saturation
Hue
Progressive
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
SAT
HUE
PROG
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
Terminal setting
Power management
Electronic sound
Key lock
Password on/off
Password
Remote control
Language
Menu category item
Last spotlight
Spotlight OSD position
Volume
IN
OFF
1
OFF
OFF
None
CH1
ENG
not selected
circle(large)
Initial position
10
TERMINAL
PMM
BVOL
KEYLOCK
------------
------------
RCCH
LANG
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
------------
------------
------------
AVOL
HKS, VKS
------------
MUTE
Keystone
P-Timer
Mute
0,0 (HKS,VKS)
0
OFF
Off
Lamp ready indicator off flag
------------
PAGE 179
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
Appendix 2 Table of Response Patterns by Command
3 付録2 コマンド別応答パターン表
Appendix 2 Table of Response Patterns by Command (1/3)
2005.11.14
Version numbers of
models supported
LOCAL
REMOTE
Response
not send
SX6
Item
Commands
ON
SX50 SX60
X600
OFF OFF2ON ON ON2OFF ON2PMM PMM PMM2ON
OFF
OFF2ON
ON2OFF ON2PMM PMM PMM2ON
BLANK
Input signal
01.00** 01.01**
DG A1 A2 CM
V
SV DV SC
X
ON OFF
1
2
REMOTE
LOCAL
○
○
○
○
POWER
ON
OFF
3
○
○
AUTOSETEXE FOCUS
VKS
4
×
○
SCRN
INPUT
5
6
7
8
9
BLANK
INPUT
AUTOPC
DOTS
TRACK
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
10 HPOS
11 VPOS
12 HPIX
13 VPIX
14 SEL
ASPECT
FULL
NORMAL
WIDE
TRUE
AUTO
–
–
–
–
15
○
← ←
← ←
← ←
○
16 IMAGE
17 BRI
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
18 CONT
19 SHARP
20 GAMMA
21 DGAMMA
22 PROG
23 WB
← ←
24 WBRGB
25 SAT
← ←
← ←
← ←
- -
26 HUE
○
○
-
27 RGBGAIN
28 RGBOFFSET
29 ACADJUST
30 MEMCADJ
31 6AXADJ
×
×
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
–
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
–
6AXR~6AXY
32
33 LAMP
34 RESET
–
–
–
–
35 VKS
36 HKS
○
–
○
–
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
37 AVOL
38 MUTE
39 BVOL
40 IMAGEFLIP
41 PMM
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
2
PJON
43 NOSIG
44 NOSHOW
45 LOGOPOS
46 LANG
TERMINAL
IN
OUT
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
47
○
×
48 KEYLOCK
49 RCCH
50 GUIDE
51 DPON
52 LEDILLUMINATE
53 ZSTEPDRV
54 ZCONTDRV
55 FSTEPDRV
56 FCONTDRV
57 RC
○
○
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
58 MAIN
59
Null
PAGE 180
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
Appendix 2 Table of Response Patterns by Command
Appendix 2 Table of Response Patterns by Command (2/3)
Version numbers of
models supported
LOCAL
REMOTE
SX6
SX50 SX60
X600
Response
not send
Item
Commands
ON
OFF OFF2ON ON ON2OFF ON2PMM PMM PMM2ON
OFF
OFF2ON
ON2OFF ON2PMM PMM PMM2ON
Input signal
BLANK
01.00** 01.01**
DG A1 A2 CM
V
SV DV SC
X
ON OFF
60 GET MODE
61 GET POWER
62 GET BLANK
63 GET INPUT
○
○
-
×
○
-
○
○
-
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
–
–
–
–
○
-
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
64 GET DOTS
65 GET TRACK
66 GET HPOS
67 GET VPOS
68 GET HPIX
69 GET VPIX
70 GET SEL
71 GET ASPECT
72 GET IMAGE
73 GET BRI
74 GET CONT
75 GET SHARP
76 GET GAMMA
77 GET DGAMMA
78 GET PROG
79 GET WB
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
80 GET WBRGB
81 GET SAT
- -
82 GET HUE
○
○
-
83 GET RGBGAIN
84 GET RGBOFFSET
85 GET ACADJUST
86 GET MEMCADJ
87 GET 6AXADJ
×
×
○
×
×
○
○
–
○
–
○
○
-
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
×
○
○
○
–
–
–
–
–
88 GET 6AXR~Y
–
–
–
–
89 GET VKS
○
–
90 GET HKS
91 GET AVOL
92 GET MUTE
○
○
-
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
–
–
93 GET BVOL
94 GET IMAGEFLIP
95 GET PMM
96 GET PJON
97 GET NOSIG
98 GET NOSHOW
99 GET LOGOPOS
100 GET LANG
101 GET LAMP
102 GET TERMINAL
103 GET KEYLOCK
104 GET RCCH
105 GET GUIDE
106 GET DPON
107 GET LEDILLUMINATE
112 GET NOSHOWSTATE
113 GET FREEZE
–
–
×
×
×
×
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
○
-
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
114 GET SIGNALSTATUS
115 GET LAMPCOUNTER
116 GET ERR
117 GET PRODCODE
118 GET ROMVER
119 GET COMVER
PAGE 181
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Command Specifications
Appendix 2 Table of Response Patterns by Command
Appendix 2 Table of Response Patterns by Command (3/3)
Version numbers of
models supported
LOCAL
REMOTE
SX6
SX50 SX60
X600
Response
not send
Item
Commands
ON
OFF OFF2ON ON ON2OFF ON2PMM PMM PMM2ON
OFF
OFF2ON
ON2OFF ON2PMM PMM PMM2ON
Input signal
BLANK
01.00** 01.01**
DG A1 A2 CM
V
SV DV SC
X
ON OFF
120 RANGE POWER
121 RANGE AUTOSETEXE
122 RANGE BLANK
123 RANGE INPUT
124 RANGE DOTS
125 RANGE TRACK
126 RANGE HPOS
127 RANGE VPOS
128 RANGE HPIX
129 RANGE VPIX
○
×
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
← ←
130 RANGE SEL
131 RANGE ASPECT
132 RANGE IMAGE
133 RANGE BRI
134 RANGE CONT
135 RANGE SHARP
136 RANGE GAMMA
137 RANGE DGAMMA
138 RANGE PROG
139 RANGE WB
← ←
← ←
140 RANGE WBRGB
141 RANGE SAT
- -
142 RANGE HUE
○
○
-
143 RANGE RGBGAIN
144 RANGE RGBOFFSET
145 RANGE ACADJUST
146 RANGE MEMCADJ
147 RANGE 6AXADJ
148 RANGE 6AXR~Y
149 RANGE VKS
150 RANGE HKS
151 RANGE AVOL
152 RANGE MUTE
153 RANGE BVOL
154 RANGE IMAGEFLIP
155 RANGE PMM
156 RANGE PJON
157 RANGE NOSIG
158 RANGE NOSHOW
159 RANGE LOGOPOS
160 RANGE LANG
×
×
○
×
○
○
×
–
–
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
×
← ←
← ←
161 RANGE LAMP
162 RANGE TERMINAL
163 RANGE KEYLOCK
164 RANGE RCCH
165 RANGE GUIDE
166 RANGE DPON
167 RANGE LEDILLUMINATE
168 RANGE ZSTEPDRV
169 RANGE ZCONTDRV
170 RANGE FSTEPDRV
–
–
×
×
×
×
×
×
171
RANGE FCONTDRV
Status
OFF
Input signal
DG Digital RGB
A1 Analog RGB1
A2 Analog RGB2
CM Component
Response
Power Off
Transitioning from power off→on
V
Video
OK or Normal response
BUSY
INVALID_MODE
INVALID_SOURCE
NO_SIGNAL
NOT_POWER_SUPPLIED
BAD_SEQUENCE
NO_BLANK
OFF2ON
ON
ON2OFF
ON2PMM
PMM
SV S-Video
DV Digital Video
SC SCART
Power ON
Transitioning from power on→off
Transitioning from power on→standby mode
V
Video
×
No signal
Standby
SV S-Video
Transitioning from standby→power on
PMM2ON
INPUT_NOT_FOUND
No response
PAGE 182
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|